Fix a segfault when creating an import library with 0 exports.
[binutils-gdb.git] / ld / ld.texi
1 \input texinfo
2 @setfilename ld.info
3 @c Copyright (C) 1991-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 @syncodeindex ky cp
5 @c man begin INCLUDE
6 @include configdoc.texi
7 @c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile)
8 @include bfdver.texi
9 @c man end
10
11 @c @smallbook
12
13 @macro gcctabopt{body}
14 @code{\body\}
15 @end macro
16
17 @c man begin NAME
18 @ifset man
19 @c Configure for the generation of man pages
20 @set UsesEnvVars
21 @set GENERIC
22 @set ARM
23 @set C6X
24 @set CSKY
25 @set H8300
26 @set HPPA
27 @set M68HC11
28 @set M68K
29 @set MIPS
30 @set MMIX
31 @set MSP430
32 @set NDS32
33 @set NIOSII
34 @set PDP11
35 @set POWERPC
36 @set POWERPC64
37 @set Renesas
38 @set S/390
39 @set SPU
40 @set TICOFF
41 @set WIN32
42 @set XTENSA
43 @end ifset
44 @c man end
45
46 @ifnottex
47 @dircategory Software development
48 @direntry
49 * Ld: (ld). The GNU linker.
50 @end direntry
51 @end ifnottex
52
53 @copying
54 This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD
55 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
56 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
57 @end ifset
58 version @value{VERSION}.
59
60 Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
61
62 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
63 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
64 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
65 with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
66 Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
67 section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
68 @end copying
69 @iftex
70 @finalout
71 @setchapternewpage odd
72 @settitle The GNU linker
73 @titlepage
74 @title The GNU linker
75 @sp 1
76 @subtitle @code{ld}
77 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
78 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
79 @end ifset
80 @subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
81 @author Steve Chamberlain
82 @author Ian Lance Taylor
83 @page
84
85 @tex
86 {\parskip=0pt
87 \hfill Red Hat Inc\par
88 \hfill nickc\@credhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par
89 \hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par
90 \hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par
91 }
92 \global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way.
93 @end tex
94
95 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
96 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
97 Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
98
99 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
100 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
101 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
102 with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
103 Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
104 section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
105 @c man end
106
107 @end titlepage
108 @end iftex
109 @contents
110 @c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker!
111
112 @ifnottex
113 @node Top
114 @top LD
115 This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld
116 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
117 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
118 @end ifset
119 version @value{VERSION}.
120
121 This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
122 Documentation License version 1.3. A copy of the license is included
123 in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
124
125 @menu
126 * Overview:: Overview
127 * Invocation:: Invocation
128 * Scripts:: Linker Scripts
129 @ifset GENERIC
130 * Machine Dependent:: Machine Dependent Features
131 @end ifset
132 @ifclear GENERIC
133 @ifset H8300
134 * H8/300:: ld and the H8/300
135 @end ifset
136 @ifset Renesas
137 * Renesas:: ld and other Renesas micros
138 @end ifset
139 @ifset ARM
140 * ARM:: ld and the ARM family
141 @end ifset
142 @ifset M68HC11
143 * M68HC11/68HC12:: ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
144 @end ifset
145 @ifset HPPA
146 * HPPA ELF32:: ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF
147 @end ifset
148 @ifset M68K
149 * M68K:: ld and Motorola 68K family
150 @end ifset
151 @ifset MIPS
152 * MIPS:: ld and MIPS family
153 @end ifset
154 @ifset POWERPC
155 * PowerPC ELF32:: ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
156 @end ifset
157 @ifset POWERPC64
158 * PowerPC64 ELF64:: ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
159 @end ifset
160 @ifset S/390
161 * S/390 ELF:: ld and S/390 ELF Support
162 @end ifset
163 @ifset SPU
164 * SPU ELF:: ld and SPU ELF Support
165 @end ifset
166 @ifset TICOFF
167 * TI COFF:: ld and the TI COFF
168 @end ifset
169 @ifset WIN32
170 * Win32:: ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
171 @end ifset
172 @ifset XTENSA
173 * Xtensa:: ld and Xtensa Processors
174 @end ifset
175 @end ifclear
176 @ifclear SingleFormat
177 * BFD:: BFD
178 @end ifclear
179 @c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus
180
181 * Reporting Bugs:: Reporting Bugs
182 * MRI:: MRI Compatible Script Files
183 * GNU Free Documentation License:: GNU Free Documentation License
184 * LD Index:: LD Index
185 @end menu
186 @end ifnottex
187
188 @node Overview
189 @chapter Overview
190
191 @cindex @sc{gnu} linker
192 @cindex what is this?
193
194 @ifset man
195 @c man begin SYNOPSIS
196 ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{}
197 @c man end
198
199 @c man begin SEEALSO
200 ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and
201 the Info entries for @file{binutils} and
202 @file{ld}.
203 @c man end
204 @end ifset
205
206 @c man begin DESCRIPTION
207
208 @command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates
209 their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in
210 compiling a program is to run @command{ld}.
211
212 @command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in
213 a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax,
214 to provide explicit and total control over the linking process.
215
216 @ifset man
217 @c For the man only
218 This man page does not describe the command language; see the
219 @command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command
220 language and on other aspects of the GNU linker.
221 @end ifset
222
223 @ifclear SingleFormat
224 This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries
225 to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and
226 write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or
227 @code{a.out}. Different formats may be linked together to produce any
228 available kind of object file. @xref{BFD}, for more information.
229 @end ifclear
230
231 Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other
232 linkers in providing diagnostic information. Many linkers abandon
233 execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
234 @command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors
235 (or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
236
237 @c man end
238
239 @node Invocation
240 @chapter Invocation
241
242 @c man begin DESCRIPTION
243
244 The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations,
245 and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers. As a result,
246 you have many choices to control its behavior.
247
248 @c man end
249
250 @ifset UsesEnvVars
251 @menu
252 * Options:: Command-line Options
253 * Environment:: Environment Variables
254 @end menu
255
256 @node Options
257 @section Command-line Options
258 @end ifset
259
260 @cindex command line
261 @cindex options
262
263 @c man begin OPTIONS
264
265 The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
266 practice few of them are used in any particular context.
267 @cindex standard Unix system
268 For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix
269 object files on a standard, supported Unix system. On such a system, to
270 link a file @code{hello.o}:
271
272 @smallexample
273 ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
274 @end smallexample
275
276 This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the
277 result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and
278 the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search
279 directories. (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.)
280
281 Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any
282 point in the command line. However, options which refer to files, such
283 as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at
284 which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object
285 files and other file options. Repeating non-file options with a
286 different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
287 occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
288 option. Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
289 noted in the descriptions below.
290
291 @cindex object files
292 Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked
293 together. They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line
294 options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between
295 an option and its argument.
296
297 Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can
298 specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R},
299 and the script command language. If @emph{no} binary input files at all
300 are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
301 message @samp{No input files}.
302
303 If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
304 assume that it is a linker script. A script specified in this way
305 augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
306 linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}). This feature
307 permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
308 or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
309 @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects. Specifying a
310 script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the
311 extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option
312 to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of
313 the @code{INSERT} command. @xref{Scripts}.
314
315 For options whose names are a single letter,
316 option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening
317 whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the
318 option that requires them.
319
320 For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can
321 precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and
322 @samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent. Note---there is one exception to
323 this rule. Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
324 only be preceded by two dashes. This is to reduce confusion with the
325 @samp{-o} option. So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file
326 name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the
327 output.
328
329 Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the
330 option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
331 immediately following the option that requires them. For example,
332 @samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent.
333 Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are
334 accepted.
335
336 Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver
337 (e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be
338 prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
339 compiler driver) like this:
340
341 @smallexample
342 gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
343 @end smallexample
344
345 This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
346 silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link. Confusion
347 may also arise when passing options that require values through a
348 driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as
349 a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
350 and the argument to the compiler. In this case, it is simplest to use
351 the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
352
353 @smallexample
354 gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
355 @end smallexample
356
357 Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU
358 linker:
359
360 @table @gcctabopt
361 @include at-file.texi
362
363 @kindex -a @var{keyword}
364 @item -a @var{keyword}
365 This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility. The @var{keyword}
366 argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or
367 @samp{default}. @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to
368 @samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent
369 to @samp{-Bdynamic}. This option may be used any number of times.
370
371 @kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
372 @item --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
373 Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
374 @var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
375 specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT}
376 will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker
377 finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries,
378 it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file.
379 This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit
380 interface.
381
382 @ifclear SingleFormat
383 @cindex binary input format
384 @kindex -b @var{format}
385 @kindex --format=@var{format}
386 @cindex input format
387 @cindex input format
388 @item -b @var{input-format}
389 @itemx --format=@var{input-format}
390 @command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
391 file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
392 @samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files
393 that follow this option on the command line. Even when @command{ld} is
394 configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need
395 to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a
396 default input format the most usual format on each machine.
397 @var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format
398 supported by the BFD libraries. (You can list the available binary
399 formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)
400 @xref{BFD}.
401
402 You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual
403 binary format. You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when
404 linking object files of different formats), by including
405 @samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a
406 particular format.
407
408 The default format is taken from the environment variable
409 @code{GNUTARGET}.
410 @ifset UsesEnvVars
411 @xref{Environment}.
412 @end ifset
413 You can also define the input format from a script, using the command
414 @code{TARGET};
415 @ifclear man
416 see @ref{Format Commands}.
417 @end ifclear
418 @end ifclear
419
420 @kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile}
421 @kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile}
422 @cindex compatibility, MRI
423 @item -c @var{MRI-commandfile}
424 @itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile}
425 For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script
426 files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in
427 @ifclear man
428 @ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}.
429 @end ifclear
430 @ifset man
431 the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation.
432 @end ifset
433 Introduce MRI script files with
434 the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker
435 scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language.
436 If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories
437 specified by any @samp{-L} options.
438
439 @cindex common allocation
440 @kindex -d
441 @kindex -dc
442 @kindex -dp
443 @item -d
444 @itemx -dc
445 @itemx -dp
446 These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for
447 compatibility with other linkers. They assign space to common symbols
448 even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}). The
449 script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
450 @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
451
452 @kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
453 @kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB}
454 @item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
455 @itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB}
456 Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
457 @var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
458 specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT}
459 will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. This
460 option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
461 The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility.
462
463 @kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions
464 @item --enable-non-contiguous-regions
465 This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not
466 fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input
467 section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an
468 error only if no output section is large enough. This is useful when
469 several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input
470 section does not require a particular one. The order in which input
471 sections are evaluated does not change, for instance:
472
473 @smallexample
474 MEMORY @{
475 MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14
476 MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40
477 MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40
478 @}
479 SECTIONS @{
480 mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1
481 mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
482 mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
483 @}
484
485 with input sections:
486 .data.1: size 8
487 .data.2: size 0x10
488 .data.3: size 4
489
490 results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3
491 affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3.
492 @end smallexample
493
494 This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes
495 the way input sections are mapped to output sections.
496
497 @kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
498 @item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
499 This option enables warnings when
500 @code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected
501 matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently
502 discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any
503 output region.
504
505 @cindex entry point, from command line
506 @kindex -e @var{entry}
507 @kindex --entry=@var{entry}
508 @item -e @var{entry}
509 @itemx --entry=@var{entry}
510 Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
511 program, rather than the default entry point. If there is no symbol
512 named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number,
513 and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in
514 base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading
515 @samp{0} for base 8). @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults
516 and other ways of specifying the entry point.
517
518 @kindex --exclude-libs
519 @item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},...
520 Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically
521 exported. The library names may be delimited by commas or colons. Specifying
522 @code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from
523 automatic export. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted
524 port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports. For i386 PE, symbols
525 explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this
526 option. For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will
527 be treated as hidden.
528
529 @kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib
530 @item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},...
531 Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols
532 should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale
533 into the import library being generated during the link. The module names
534 may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames
535 used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply
536 the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and
537 match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
538 command-line. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port
539 of the linker. Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported,
540 regardless of this option.
541
542 @cindex dynamic symbol table
543 @kindex -E
544 @kindex --export-dynamic
545 @kindex --no-export-dynamic
546 @item -E
547 @itemx --export-dynamic
548 @itemx --no-export-dynamic
549 When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E}
550 option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add
551 all symbols to the dynamic symbol table. The dynamic symbol table is the
552 set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time.
553
554 If you do not use either of these options (or use the
555 @option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the
556 dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are
557 referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
558
559 If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
560 back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
561 dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
562 linking the program itself.
563
564 You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
565 be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it.
566 See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}.
567
568 Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports. PE targets
569 support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see
570 the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below.
571
572 @kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
573 @cindex export dynamic symbol
574 @item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
575 When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching
576 @var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a
577 shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be
578 bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a
579 no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or
580 @samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful
581 on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
582
583 @kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
584 @cindex export dynamic symbol list
585 @item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
586 Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file.
587 The format of the file is the same as the version node without
588 scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
589
590 @ifclear SingleFormat
591 @cindex big-endian objects
592 @cindex endianness
593 @kindex -EB
594 @item -EB
595 Link big-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
596
597 @cindex little-endian objects
598 @kindex -EL
599 @item -EL
600 Link little-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
601 @end ifclear
602
603 @kindex -f @var{name}
604 @kindex --auxiliary=@var{name}
605 @item -f @var{name}
606 @itemx --auxiliary=@var{name}
607 When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field
608 to the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol
609 table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the
610 symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
611
612 If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
613 run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field. If
614 the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will
615 first check whether there is a definition in the shared object
616 @var{name}. If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition
617 in the filter object. The shared object @var{name} need not exist.
618 Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative
619 implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for
620 machine-specific performance.
621
622 This option may be specified more than once. The DT_AUXILIARY entries
623 will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line.
624
625 @kindex -F @var{name}
626 @kindex --filter=@var{name}
627 @item -F @var{name}
628 @itemx --filter=@var{name}
629 When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to
630 the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table
631 of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter
632 on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
633
634 If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
635 run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field. The
636 dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the
637 filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions
638 found in the shared object @var{name}. Thus the filter object can be
639 used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object
640 @var{name}.
641
642 Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation
643 toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output
644 object files.
645 @ifclear SingleFormat
646 The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the
647 @option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the
648 @code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET}
649 environment variable.
650 @end ifclear
651 The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not
652 creating an ELF shared object.
653
654 @cindex finalization function
655 @kindex -fini=@var{name}
656 @item -fini=@var{name}
657 When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
658 executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the
659 address of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as
660 the function to call.
661
662 @kindex -g
663 @item -g
664 Ignored. Provided for compatibility with other tools.
665
666 @kindex -G @var{value}
667 @kindex --gpsize=@var{value}
668 @cindex object size
669 @item -G @var{value}
670 @itemx --gpsize=@var{value}
671 Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to
672 @var{size}. This is only meaningful for object file formats such as
673 MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different
674 sections. This is ignored for other object file formats.
675
676 @cindex runtime library name
677 @kindex -h @var{name}
678 @kindex -soname=@var{name}
679 @item -h @var{name}
680 @itemx -soname=@var{name}
681 When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to
682 the specified name. When an executable is linked with a shared object
683 which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic
684 linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME
685 field rather than the using the file name given to the linker.
686
687 @kindex -i
688 @cindex incremental link
689 @item -i
690 Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}).
691
692 @cindex initialization function
693 @kindex -init=@var{name}
694 @item -init=@var{name}
695 When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
696 executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address
697 of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the
698 function to call.
699
700 @cindex archive files, from cmd line
701 @kindex -l @var{namespec}
702 @kindex --library=@var{namespec}
703 @item -l @var{namespec}
704 @itemx --library=@var{namespec}
705 Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the
706 list of files to link. This option may be used any number of times.
707 If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld}
708 will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it
709 will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.
710
711 On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for
712 files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. Specifically, on ELF
713 and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library
714 called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called
715 @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. (By convention, a @code{.so} extension
716 indicates a shared library.) Note that this behavior does not apply
717 to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called
718 @var{filename}.
719
720 The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is
721 specified on the command line. If the archive defines a symbol which
722 was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the
723 command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the
724 archive. However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on
725 the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again.
726
727 See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search
728 archives multiple times.
729
730 You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
731
732 @ifset GENERIC
733 This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers. However,
734 if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the
735 behaviour of the AIX linker.
736 @end ifset
737
738 @cindex search directory, from cmd line
739 @kindex -L @var{dir}
740 @kindex --library-path=@var{dir}
741 @item -L @var{searchdir}
742 @itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir}
743 Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search
744 for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts. You may use this
745 option any number of times. The directories are searched in the order
746 in which they are specified on the command line. Directories specified
747 on the command line are searched before the default directories. All
748 @option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the
749 order in which the options appear. @option{-L} options do not affect
750 how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T}
751 option is specified.
752
753 If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this
754 prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the
755 @samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured.
756
757 @ifset UsesEnvVars
758 The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
759 @samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in
760 some cases also on how it was configured. @xref{Environment}.
761 @end ifset
762
763 The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
764 @code{SEARCH_DIR} command. Directories specified this way are searched
765 at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line.
766
767 @cindex emulation
768 @kindex -m @var{emulation}
769 @item -m @var{emulation}
770 Emulate the @var{emulation} linker. You can list the available
771 emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.
772
773 If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
774 @code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined.
775
776 Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
777 configured.
778
779 @cindex link map
780 @kindex -M
781 @kindex --print-map
782 @item -M
783 @itemx --print-map
784 Print a link map to the standard output. A link map provides
785 information about the link, including the following:
786
787 @itemize @bullet
788 @item
789 Where object files are mapped into memory.
790 @item
791 How common symbols are allocated.
792 @item
793 All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol
794 which caused the archive member to be brought in.
795 @item
796 The values assigned to symbols.
797
798 Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which
799 involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not
800 have correct result displayed in the link map. This is because the
801 linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value
802 of an expression. Under such circumstances the linker will display
803 the final value enclosed by square brackets. Thus for example a
804 linker script containing:
805
806 @smallexample
807 foo = 1
808 foo = foo * 4
809 foo = foo + 8
810 @end smallexample
811
812 will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M}
813 option is used:
814
815 @smallexample
816 0x00000001 foo = 0x1
817 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo * 0x4)
818 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo + 0x8)
819 @end smallexample
820
821 See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker
822 scripts.
823
824 @item
825 How GNU properties are merged.
826
827 When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output
828 .note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated.
829 These actions are reported in the link map. For example:
830
831 @smallexample
832 Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found)
833 @end smallexample
834
835 This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when
836 merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value
837 is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002.
838
839 @smallexample
840 Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1)
841 @end smallexample
842
843 This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output
844 when merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value
845 is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1.
846 @end itemize
847
848 @cindex link map discarded
849 @kindex --print-map-discarded
850 @kindex --no-print-map-discarded
851 @item --print-map-discarded
852 @itemx --no-print-map-discarded
853 Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections
854 in the link map. Enabled by default.
855
856 @kindex -n
857 @cindex read-only text
858 @cindex NMAGIC
859 @kindex --nmagic
860 @item -n
861 @itemx --nmagic
862 Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared
863 libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
864 mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}.
865
866 @kindex -N
867 @kindex --omagic
868 @cindex read/write from cmd line
869 @cindex OMAGIC
870 @item -N
871 @itemx --omagic
872 Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable. Also, do
873 not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared
874 libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
875 mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section
876 is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format
877 specification published by Microsoft.
878
879 @kindex --no-omagic
880 @cindex OMAGIC
881 @item --no-omagic
882 This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option. It
883 sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to
884 be page-aligned. Note - this option does not enable linking against
885 shared libraries. Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this.
886
887 @kindex -o @var{output}
888 @kindex --output=@var{output}
889 @cindex naming the output file
890 @item -o @var{output}
891 @itemx --output=@var{output}
892 Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this
893 option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default. The
894 script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name.
895
896 @kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
897 @cindex dependency file
898 @item --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
899 Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}. This file contains a rule
900 suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files
901 that were read to produce it. The output is similar to the compiler's
902 output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options
903 Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler
904 Collection}). Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM},
905 to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the
906 linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler). So the output from
907 @samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the
908 installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into
909 distributed makefiles without careful editing.
910
911 @kindex -O @var{level}
912 @cindex generating optimized output
913 @item -O @var{level}
914 If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes
915 the output. This might take significantly longer and therefore probably
916 should only be enabled for the final binary. At the moment this
917 option only affects ELF shared library generation. Future releases of
918 the linker may make more use of this option. Also currently there is
919 no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values
920 of this option. Again this may change with future releases.
921
922 @kindex -plugin @var{name}
923 @item -plugin @var{name}
924 Involve a plugin in the linking process. The @var{name} parameter is
925 the absolute filename of the plugin. Usually this parameter is
926 automatically added by the complier, when using link time
927 optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so
928 wish.
929
930 Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different
931 from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and
932 @command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins. In order for
933 those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be
934 copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory. All gcc
935 based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to
936 just copy in the newest one.
937
938 @kindex --push-state
939 @cindex push state governing input file handling
940 @item --push-state
941 The @option{--push-state} allows to preserve the current state of the
942 flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
943 restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option.
944
945 The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic},
946 @option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared},
947 @option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive},
948 @option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur},
949 @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries},
950 @option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}.
951
952 One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}. When
953 used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are
954 listed and then possibly linked with all the time. It is better to return
955 something as follows:
956
957 @smallexample
958 -Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
959 @end smallexample
960
961 @kindex --pop-state
962 @cindex pop state governing input file handling
963 @item --pop-state
964 Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the
965 flags governing input file handling.
966
967 @kindex -q
968 @kindex --emit-relocs
969 @cindex retain relocations in final executable
970 @item -q
971 @itemx --emit-relocs
972 Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
973 Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in
974 order to perform correct modifications of executables. This results
975 in larger executables.
976
977 This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
978
979 @kindex --force-dynamic
980 @cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections
981 @item --force-dynamic
982 Force the output file to have dynamic sections. This option is specific
983 to VxWorks targets.
984
985 @cindex partial link
986 @cindex relocatable output
987 @kindex -r
988 @kindex --relocatable
989 @item -r
990 @itemx --relocatable
991 Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in
992 turn serve as input to @command{ld}. This is often called @dfn{partial
993 linking}. As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix
994 magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to
995 @code{OMAGIC}.
996 @c ; see @option{-N}.
997 If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced. When
998 linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to
999 constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}.
1000
1001 When an input file does not have the same format as the output file,
1002 partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any
1003 relocations. Different output formats can have further restrictions; for
1004 example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking
1005 with input files in other formats at all.
1006
1007 This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}.
1008
1009 @kindex -R @var{file}
1010 @kindex --just-symbols=@var{file}
1011 @cindex symbol-only input
1012 @item -R @var{filename}
1013 @itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename}
1014 Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not
1015 relocate it or include it in the output. This allows your output file
1016 to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other
1017 programs. You may use this option more than once.
1018
1019 For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
1020 followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
1021 the @option{-rpath} option.
1022
1023 @kindex -s
1024 @kindex --strip-all
1025 @cindex strip all symbols
1026 @item -s
1027 @itemx --strip-all
1028 Omit all symbol information from the output file.
1029
1030 @kindex -S
1031 @kindex --strip-debug
1032 @cindex strip debugger symbols
1033 @item -S
1034 @itemx --strip-debug
1035 Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file.
1036
1037 @kindex --strip-discarded
1038 @kindex --no-strip-discarded
1039 @item --strip-discarded
1040 @itemx --no-strip-discarded
1041 Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections.
1042 Enabled by default.
1043
1044 @kindex -t
1045 @kindex --trace
1046 @cindex input files, displaying
1047 @item -t
1048 @itemx --trace
1049 Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them. If
1050 @samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed.
1051 @samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files
1052 and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for
1053 a linker bug report.
1054
1055 @kindex -T @var{script}
1056 @kindex --script=@var{script}
1057 @cindex script files
1058 @item -T @var{scriptfile}
1059 @itemx --script=@var{scriptfile}
1060 Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script. This script replaces
1061 @command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it), so
1062 @var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the
1063 output file. @xref{Scripts}. If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in
1064 the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories
1065 specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options. Multiple @samp{-T}
1066 options accumulate.
1067
1068 @kindex -dT @var{script}
1069 @kindex --default-script=@var{script}
1070 @cindex script files
1071 @item -dT @var{scriptfile}
1072 @itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile}
1073 Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script. @xref{Scripts}.
1074
1075 This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that
1076 processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
1077 command line has been processed. This allows options placed after the
1078 @option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the
1079 behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker
1080 command line cannot be directly controlled by the user. (eg because
1081 the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as
1082 @samp{gcc}).
1083
1084 @kindex -u @var{symbol}
1085 @kindex --undefined=@var{symbol}
1086 @cindex undefined symbol
1087 @item -u @var{symbol}
1088 @itemx --undefined=@var{symbol}
1089 Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
1090 symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
1091 modules from standard libraries. @samp{-u} may be repeated with
1092 different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols. This
1093 option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command.
1094
1095 If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled
1096 into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain
1097 undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used
1098 instead.
1099
1100 @kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1101 @cindex symbols, require defined
1102 @cindex defined symbol
1103 @item --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1104 Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file. This option
1105 is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol}
1106 is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error
1107 and exit. The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using
1108 @code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together. This option
1109 can be used multiple times to require additional symbols.
1110
1111 @kindex -Ur
1112 @cindex constructors
1113 @item -Ur
1114 For anything other than C++ programs, this option is equivalent to
1115 @samp{-r}: it generates relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in
1116 turn serve as input to @command{ld}. When linking C++ programs, @samp{-Ur}
1117 @emph{does} resolve references to constructors, unlike @samp{-r}.
1118 It does not work to use @samp{-Ur} on files that were themselves linked
1119 with @samp{-Ur}; once the constructor table has been built, it cannot
1120 be added to. Use @samp{-Ur} only for the last partial link, and
1121 @samp{-r} for the others.
1122
1123 @kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1124 @cindex orphan sections
1125 @cindex sections, orphan
1126 @item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1127 Control how orphan sections are handled. An orphan section is one not
1128 specifically mentioned in a linker script. @xref{Orphan Sections}.
1129
1130 @var{MODE} can have any of the following values:
1131
1132 @table @code
1133 @item place
1134 Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following
1135 the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}. The option
1136 @samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed.
1137
1138 @item discard
1139 All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the
1140 @samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}).
1141
1142 @item warn
1143 The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also
1144 issue a warning.
1145
1146 @item error
1147 The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found.
1148 @end table
1149
1150 The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}.
1151
1152 @kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1153 @item --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1154 Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
1155 @var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is
1156 missing, for every orphan input section. An orphan section is one not
1157 specifically mentioned in a linker script. You may use this option
1158 multiple times on the command line; It prevents the normal merging of
1159 input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments
1160 in a linker script.
1161
1162 @kindex -v
1163 @kindex -V
1164 @kindex --version
1165 @cindex version
1166 @item -v
1167 @itemx --version
1168 @itemx -V
1169 Display the version number for @command{ld}. The @option{-V} option also
1170 lists the supported emulations.
1171
1172 @kindex -x
1173 @kindex --discard-all
1174 @cindex deleting local symbols
1175 @item -x
1176 @itemx --discard-all
1177 Delete all local symbols.
1178
1179 @kindex -X
1180 @kindex --discard-locals
1181 @cindex local symbols, deleting
1182 @item -X
1183 @itemx --discard-locals
1184 Delete all temporary local symbols. (These symbols start with
1185 system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
1186 or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.)
1187
1188 @kindex -y @var{symbol}
1189 @kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1190 @cindex symbol tracing
1191 @item -y @var{symbol}
1192 @itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1193 Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears. This
1194 option may be given any number of times. On many systems it is necessary
1195 to prepend an underscore.
1196
1197 This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but
1198 don't know where the reference is coming from.
1199
1200 @kindex -Y @var{path}
1201 @item -Y @var{path}
1202 Add @var{path} to the default library search path. This option exists
1203 for Solaris compatibility.
1204
1205 @kindex -z @var{keyword}
1206 @item -z @var{keyword}
1207 The recognized keywords are:
1208 @table @samp
1209
1210 @item bndplt
1211 Always generate BND prefix in PLT entries. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1212
1213 @item call-nop=prefix-addr
1214 @itemx call-nop=suffix-nop
1215 @itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}
1216 @itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}
1217 Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call
1218 to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot.
1219 @option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}.
1220 @option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}.
1221 @option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}.
1222 @option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}.
1223 Supported for i386 and x86_64.
1224
1225 @item cet-report=none
1226 @itemx cet-report=warning
1227 @itemx cet-report=error
1228 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and
1229 GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property
1230 section. @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1231 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1232 @option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1233 missing properties in input files. @option{cet-report=error} will make
1234 the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1235 Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing
1236 GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will
1237 turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report.
1238 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1239
1240 @item combreloc
1241 @itemx nocombreloc
1242 Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve
1243 dynamic symbol lookup caching. Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}.
1244
1245 @item common
1246 @itemx nocommon
1247 Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable
1248 link. Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}.
1249
1250 @item common-page-size=@var{value}
1251 Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}. Memory image
1252 layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is
1253 using pages of this size.
1254
1255 @item defs
1256 Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1257 is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1258 This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}.
1259
1260 @item dynamic-undefined-weak
1261 @itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak
1262 Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object,
1263 if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local
1264 by symbol visibility or versioning. Do not make them dynamic if
1265 @samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}. If neither option is given, a target
1266 may default to either option being in force, or make some other
1267 selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic. Not all targets support
1268 these options.
1269
1270 @item execstack
1271 Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
1272
1273 @item global
1274 This option is only meaningful when building a shared object. It makes
1275 the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution
1276 of subsequently loaded libraries.
1277
1278 @item globalaudit
1279 This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable.
1280 This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by
1281 setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic
1282 tag. Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via
1283 the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for
1284 all dynamic objects loaded by the application.
1285
1286 @item ibtplt
1287 Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries.
1288 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1289
1290 @item ibt
1291 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section
1292 to indicate compatibility with IBT. This also implies @option{ibtplt}.
1293 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1294
1295 @item initfirst
1296 This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
1297 It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur
1298 before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into
1299 the process at the same time. Similarly the runtime finalization of
1300 the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other
1301 objects.
1302
1303 @item interpose
1304 Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order
1305 so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared
1306 libraries not so marked.
1307
1308 @item lazy
1309 When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1310 dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when
1311 the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time.
1312 Lazy binding is the default.
1313
1314 @item loadfltr
1315 Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime.
1316
1317 @item max-page-size=@var{value}
1318 Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}.
1319
1320 @item muldefs
1321 Allow multiple definitions.
1322
1323 @item nocopyreloc
1324 Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables
1325 defined in shared libraries. May result in dynamic text relocations.
1326
1327 @item nodefaultlib
1328 Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object
1329 should ignore any default library search paths.
1330
1331 @item nodelete
1332 Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
1333
1334 @item nodlopen
1335 Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}.
1336
1337 @item nodump
1338 Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}.
1339
1340 @item noexecstack
1341 Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
1342
1343 @item noextern-protected-data
1344 Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared
1345 library. This option overrides the linker backend default. It can be
1346 used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols
1347 generated by compiler. Updates on protected data symbols by another
1348 module aren't visible to the resulting shared library. Supported for
1349 i386 and x86-64.
1350
1351 @item noreloc-overflow
1352 Disable relocation overflow check. This can be used to disable
1353 relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation
1354 overflow at run-time. Supported for x86_64.
1355
1356 @item now
1357 When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1358 dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or
1359 when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring
1360 function call resolution to the point when the function is first
1361 called.
1362
1363 @item origin
1364 Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths.
1365
1366 @item relro
1367 @itemx norelro
1368 Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object. This
1369 specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after
1370 relocation, if supported. Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller
1371 than the system page size will render this protection ineffective.
1372 Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}.
1373
1374 @item separate-code
1375 @itemx noseparate-code
1376 Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object. This
1377 specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must
1378 be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data. Don't create separate
1379 code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used.
1380
1381 @item shstk
1382 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section
1383 to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack. Supported for
1384 Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1385
1386 @item stack-size=@var{value}
1387 Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment.
1388 Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
1389 @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation.
1390
1391 @item start-stop-visibility=@var{value}
1392 @cindex visibility
1393 @cindex ELF symbol visibility
1394 Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized
1395 @code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input
1396 Section Example}). @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default},
1397 @samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}. If no @samp{-z
1398 start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for
1399 compatibility with historical practice. However, it's highly
1400 recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new
1401 programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported
1402 between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended.
1403
1404 @item text
1405 @itemx notext
1406 @itemx textoff
1407 Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent
1408 or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections. Don't
1409 report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}.
1410
1411 @item undefs
1412 Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files,
1413 either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library.
1414 This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}.
1415
1416 @end table
1417
1418 Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
1419
1420 @kindex -(
1421 @cindex groups of archives
1422 @item -( @var{archives} -)
1423 @itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group
1424 The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files. They may be
1425 either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options.
1426
1427 The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined
1428 references are created. Normally, an archive is searched only once in
1429 the order that it is specified on the command line. If a symbol in that
1430 archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an
1431 object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker
1432 would not be able to resolve that reference. By grouping the archives,
1433 they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are
1434 resolved.
1435
1436 Using this option has a significant performance cost. It is best to use
1437 it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or
1438 more archives.
1439
1440 @kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch
1441 @kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1442 @item --accept-unknown-input-arch
1443 @itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1444 Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
1445 recognised. The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing
1446 and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files. This was
1447 the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14. The default
1448 behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and
1449 so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to
1450 restore the old behaviour.
1451
1452 @kindex --as-needed
1453 @kindex --no-as-needed
1454 @item --as-needed
1455 @itemx --no-as-needed
1456 This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned
1457 on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option. Normally
1458 the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned
1459 on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually
1460 needed or not. @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be
1461 emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a
1462 non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if
1463 the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a
1464 non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.
1465 Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after}
1466 the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
1467 needed. This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files
1468 from archives. @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour.
1469
1470 @kindex --add-needed
1471 @kindex --no-add-needed
1472 @item --add-needed
1473 @itemx --no-add-needed
1474 These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
1475 their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed}
1476 options. They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1477 and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
1478
1479 @kindex -assert @var{keyword}
1480 @item -assert @var{keyword}
1481 This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
1482
1483 @kindex -Bdynamic
1484 @kindex -dy
1485 @kindex -call_shared
1486 @item -Bdynamic
1487 @itemx -dy
1488 @itemx -call_shared
1489 Link against dynamic libraries. This is only meaningful on platforms
1490 for which shared libraries are supported. This option is normally the
1491 default on such platforms. The different variants of this option are
1492 for compatibility with various systems. You may use this option
1493 multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for
1494 @option{-l} options which follow it.
1495
1496 @kindex -Bgroup
1497 @item -Bgroup
1498 Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic
1499 section. This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
1500 object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
1501 @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied. This option is
1502 only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
1503
1504 @kindex -Bstatic
1505 @kindex -dn
1506 @kindex -non_shared
1507 @kindex -static
1508 @item -Bstatic
1509 @itemx -dn
1510 @itemx -non_shared
1511 @itemx -static
1512 Do not link against shared libraries. This is only meaningful on
1513 platforms for which shared libraries are supported. The different
1514 variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems. You
1515 may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
1516 library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it. This
1517 option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}. This
1518 option can be used with @option{-shared}. Doing so means that a
1519 shared library is being created but that all of the library's external
1520 references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static
1521 libraries.
1522
1523 @kindex -Bsymbolic
1524 @item -Bsymbolic
1525 When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the
1526 definition within the shared library, if any. Normally, it is possible
1527 for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition
1528 within the shared library. This option is only meaningful on ELF
1529 platforms which support shared libraries.
1530
1531 @kindex -Bsymbolic-functions
1532 @item -Bsymbolic-functions
1533 When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
1534 symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.
1535 This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
1536 libraries.
1537
1538 @kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1539 @item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1540 Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker. This is
1541 typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
1542 global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition
1543 within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables
1544 to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table
1545 in the executable. This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms
1546 which support shared libraries.
1547
1548 The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without
1549 scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
1550
1551 @kindex --dynamic-list-data
1552 @item --dynamic-list-data
1553 Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
1554
1555 @kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1556 @item --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1557 Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete. It
1558 is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
1559
1560 @kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1561 @item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1562 Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification.
1563
1564 @kindex --check-sections
1565 @kindex --no-check-sections
1566 @item --check-sections
1567 @itemx --no-check-sections
1568 Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have
1569 been assigned to see if there are any overlaps. Normally the linker will
1570 perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce
1571 suitable error messages. The linker does know about, and does make
1572 allowances for sections in overlays. The default behaviour can be
1573 restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}.
1574 Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links. You can
1575 force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections}
1576 option.
1577
1578 @kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries
1579 @kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1580 @item --copy-dt-needed-entries
1581 @itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1582 This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
1583 by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
1584 command line. Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
1585 output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
1586 input dynamic library. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1587 specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that
1588 follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added. The default
1589 behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
1590
1591 This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic
1592 libraries. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries
1593 mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following
1594 their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols
1595 required by the output binary. With the default setting however
1596 the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the
1597 dynamic library itself. No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve
1598 symbols.
1599
1600 @cindex cross reference table
1601 @kindex --cref
1602 @item --cref
1603 Output a cross reference table. If a linker map file is being
1604 generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
1605 Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
1606
1607 The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
1608 easily processed by a script if necessary. The symbols are printed out,
1609 sorted by name. For each symbol, a list of file names is given. If the
1610 symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the
1611 definition. If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files
1612 where this happens appear next. Finally any files that reference the
1613 symbol are listed.
1614
1615 @cindex ctf variables
1616 @kindex --ctf-variables
1617 @kindex --no-ctf-variables
1618 @item --ctf-variables
1619 @item --no-ctf-variables
1620 The CTF debuginfo format supports a section which encodes the names and
1621 types of variables found in the program which do not appear in any symbol
1622 table. These variables clearly cannot be looked up by address by
1623 conventional debuggers, so the space used for their types and names is
1624 usually wasted: the types are usually small but the names are often not.
1625 @option{--ctf-variables} causes the generation of such a section.
1626 The default behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-ctf-variables}.
1627
1628 @cindex ctf type sharing
1629 @kindex --ctf-share-types
1630 @item --ctf-share-types=@var{method}
1631 Adjust the method used to share types between translation units in CTF.
1632
1633 @table @samp
1634 @item share-unconflicted
1635 Put all types that do not have ambiguous definitions into the shared dictionary,
1636 where debuggers can easily access them, even if they only occur in one
1637 translation unit. This is the default.
1638
1639 @item share-duplicated
1640 Put only types that occur in multiple translation units into the shared
1641 dictionary: types with only one definition go into per-translation-unit
1642 dictionaries. Types with ambiguous definitions in multiple translation units
1643 always go into per-translation-unit dictionaries. This tends to make the CTF
1644 larger, but may reduce the amount of CTF in the shared dictionary. For very
1645 large projects this may speed up opening the CTF and save memory in the CTF
1646 consumer at runtime.
1647 @end table
1648
1649 @cindex common allocation
1650 @kindex --no-define-common
1651 @item --no-define-common
1652 This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
1653 The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
1654 @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1655
1656 The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling
1657 the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice
1658 of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type
1659 forces assigning addresses to Common symbols.
1660 Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced
1661 from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program.
1662 This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library,
1663 and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
1664 duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search
1665 paths for runtime symbol resolution.
1666
1667 @cindex group allocation in linker script
1668 @cindex section groups
1669 @cindex COMDAT
1670 @kindex --force-group-allocation
1671 @item --force-group-allocation
1672 This option causes the linker to place section group members like
1673 normal input sections, and to delete the section groups. This is the
1674 default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to
1675 change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}). The script
1676 command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same
1677 effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1678
1679 @cindex symbols, from command line
1680 @kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp}
1681 @item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression}
1682 Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
1683 address given by @var{expression}. You may use this option as many
1684 times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line. A
1685 limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this
1686 context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing
1687 symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal
1688 constants or symbols. If you need more elaborate expressions, consider
1689 using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}).
1690 @emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the
1691 equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}.
1692
1693 @cindex demangling, from command line
1694 @kindex --demangle[=@var{style}]
1695 @kindex --no-demangle
1696 @item --demangle[=@var{style}]
1697 @itemx --no-demangle
1698 These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages
1699 and other output. When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to
1700 present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading
1701 underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++
1702 mangled symbol names into user readable names. Different compilers have
1703 different mangling styles. The optional demangling style argument can be used
1704 to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler. The linker will
1705 demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}
1706 is set. These options may be used to override the default.
1707
1708 @cindex dynamic linker, from command line
1709 @kindex -I@var{file}
1710 @kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1711 @item -I@var{file}
1712 @itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1713 Set the name of the dynamic linker. This is only meaningful when
1714 generating dynamically linked ELF executables. The default dynamic
1715 linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are
1716 doing.
1717
1718 @kindex --no-dynamic-linker
1719 @item --no-dynamic-linker
1720 When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic
1721 linker to be used at load-time. This is only meaningful for ELF
1722 executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires
1723 entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations.
1724
1725 @kindex --embedded-relocs
1726 @item --embedded-relocs
1727 This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except
1728 that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section. This option
1729 is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K}
1730 targets.
1731
1732 @kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1733 @item --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1734 Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included
1735 in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols
1736
1737 @kindex --fatal-warnings
1738 @kindex --no-fatal-warnings
1739 @item --fatal-warnings
1740 @itemx --no-fatal-warnings
1741 Treat all warnings as errors. The default behaviour can be restored
1742 with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}.
1743
1744 @kindex --force-exe-suffix
1745 @item --force-exe-suffix
1746 Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
1747
1748 If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
1749 @code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy
1750 the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This
1751 option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft
1752 Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless
1753 it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix.
1754
1755 @kindex --gc-sections
1756 @kindex --no-gc-sections
1757 @cindex garbage collection
1758 @item --gc-sections
1759 @itemx --no-gc-sections
1760 Enable garbage collection of unused input sections. It is ignored on
1761 targets that do not support this option. The default behaviour (of not
1762 performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying
1763 @samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line. Note that garbage
1764 collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the
1765 implementation is currently considered to be experimental.
1766
1767 @samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by
1768 examining symbols and relocations. The section containing the entry
1769 symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the
1770 command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols
1771 referenced by dynamic objects. Note that when building shared
1772 libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is
1773 referenced. Once this initial set of sections has been determined,
1774 the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
1775 relocations. See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and
1776 @samp{--gc-keep-exported}.
1777
1778 This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option
1779 @samp{-r}). In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly
1780 specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry},
1781 @samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY}
1782 command in the linker script.
1783
1784 @kindex --print-gc-sections
1785 @kindex --no-print-gc-sections
1786 @cindex garbage collection
1787 @item --print-gc-sections
1788 @itemx --no-print-gc-sections
1789 List all sections removed by garbage collection. The listing is
1790 printed on stderr. This option is only effective if garbage
1791 collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option. The
1792 default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can
1793 be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command
1794 line.
1795
1796 @kindex --gc-keep-exported
1797 @cindex garbage collection
1798 @item --gc-keep-exported
1799 When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage
1800 collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having
1801 default or protected visibility. This option is intended to be used for
1802 executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage
1803 collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols.
1804 Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since
1805 it is already the default behaviour. This option is only supported for
1806 ELF format targets.
1807
1808 @kindex --print-output-format
1809 @cindex output format
1810 @item --print-output-format
1811 Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
1812 other command-line options). This is the string that would appear
1813 in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}).
1814
1815 @kindex --print-memory-usage
1816 @cindex memory usage
1817 @item --print-memory-usage
1818 Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with
1819 the @ref{MEMORY} command. This is useful on embedded targets to have a
1820 quick view of amount of free memory. The format of the output has one
1821 headline and one line per region. It is both human readable and easily
1822 parsable by tools. Here is an example of an output:
1823
1824 @smallexample
1825 Memory region Used Size Region Size %age Used
1826 ROM: 256 KB 1 MB 25.00%
1827 RAM: 32 B 2 GB 0.00%
1828 @end smallexample
1829
1830 @cindex help
1831 @cindex usage
1832 @kindex --help
1833 @item --help
1834 Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit.
1835
1836 @kindex --target-help
1837 @item --target-help
1838 Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit.
1839
1840 @kindex -Map=@var{mapfile}
1841 @item -Map=@var{mapfile}
1842 Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}. See the description of the
1843 @option{-M} option, above. Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile}
1844 causes the linker map to be written into a file inside the directory.
1845 The name of the file is based upon the @var{output} filename with
1846 @code{.map} appended.
1847
1848 @cindex memory usage
1849 @kindex --no-keep-memory
1850 @item --no-keep-memory
1851 @command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
1852 symbol tables of input files in memory. This option tells @command{ld} to
1853 instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as
1854 necessary. This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space
1855 while linking a large executable.
1856
1857 @kindex --no-undefined
1858 @kindex -z defs
1859 @kindex -z undefs
1860 @item --no-undefined
1861 @itemx -z defs
1862 Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1863 is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1864 The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the
1865 behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
1866 libraries being linked in.
1867
1868 The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}.
1869
1870 @kindex --allow-multiple-definition
1871 @kindex -z muldefs
1872 @item --allow-multiple-definition
1873 @itemx -z muldefs
1874 Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
1875 report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the
1876 first definition will be used.
1877
1878 @kindex --allow-shlib-undefined
1879 @kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined
1880 @item --allow-shlib-undefined
1881 @itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined
1882 Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.
1883 This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it
1884 determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a
1885 shared library rather than a regular object file. It does not affect
1886 how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
1887
1888 The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
1889 referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create
1890 an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create
1891 a shared library.
1892
1893 The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
1894 libraries specified at link time are that:
1895
1896 @itemize @bullet
1897 @item
1898 A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one
1899 that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be
1900 resolvable at load time.
1901 @item
1902 There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined
1903 symbols in shared libraries are normal.
1904
1905 The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to
1906 select whichever function is most appropriate for the current
1907 architecture. This is used, for example, to dynamically select an
1908 appropriate memset function.
1909 @end itemize
1910
1911 @kindex --no-undefined-version
1912 @item --no-undefined-version
1913 Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore
1914 it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error
1915 will be issued instead.
1916
1917 @kindex --default-symver
1918 @item --default-symver
1919 Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
1920 exported symbols.
1921
1922 @kindex --default-imported-symver
1923 @item --default-imported-symver
1924 Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
1925 imported symbols.
1926
1927 @kindex --no-warn-mismatch
1928 @item --no-warn-mismatch
1929 Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input
1930 files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have
1931 been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses.
1932 This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible
1933 errors. This option should only be used with care, in cases when you
1934 have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are
1935 inappropriate.
1936
1937 @kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch
1938 @item --no-warn-search-mismatch
1939 Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
1940 library during a library search. This option silences the warning.
1941
1942 @kindex --no-whole-archive
1943 @item --no-whole-archive
1944 Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent
1945 archive files.
1946
1947 @cindex output file after errors
1948 @kindex --noinhibit-exec
1949 @item --noinhibit-exec
1950 Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
1951 Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters
1952 errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file
1953 when it issues any error whatsoever.
1954
1955 @kindex -nostdlib
1956 @item -nostdlib
1957 Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
1958 command line. Library directories specified in linker scripts
1959 (including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored.
1960
1961 @ifclear SingleFormat
1962 @kindex --oformat=@var{output-format}
1963 @item --oformat=@var{output-format}
1964 @command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
1965 file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
1966 @samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output
1967 object file. Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative
1968 object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld}
1969 should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
1970 usual format on each machine. @var{output-format} is a text string, the
1971 name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries. (You can
1972 list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.) The script
1973 command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but
1974 this option overrides it. @xref{BFD}.
1975 @end ifclear
1976
1977 @kindex --out-implib
1978 @item --out-implib @var{file}
1979 Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable
1980 the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program). This import
1981 library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs)
1982 may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this
1983 behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation
1984 step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs). This option is only available for
1985 the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker.
1986
1987 @kindex -pie
1988 @kindex --pic-executable
1989 @item -pie
1990 @itemx --pic-executable
1991 @cindex position independent executables
1992 Create a position independent executable. This is currently only supported on
1993 ELF platforms. Position independent executables are similar to shared
1994 libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual
1995 address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations). Like
1996 normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols
1997 defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
1998
1999 @kindex -qmagic
2000 @item -qmagic
2001 This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
2002
2003 @kindex -Qy
2004 @item -Qy
2005 This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
2006
2007 @kindex --relax
2008 @cindex synthesizing linker
2009 @cindex relaxing addressing modes
2010 @cindex --no-relax
2011 @item --relax
2012 @itemx --no-relax
2013 An option with machine dependent effects.
2014 @ifset GENERIC
2015 This option is only supported on a few targets.
2016 @end ifset
2017 @ifset H8300
2018 @xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}.
2019 @end ifset
2020 @ifset XTENSA
2021 @xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}.
2022 @end ifset
2023 @ifset M68HC11
2024 @xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}.
2025 @end ifset
2026 @ifset NIOSII
2027 @xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}.
2028 @end ifset
2029 @ifset POWERPC
2030 @xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}.
2031 @end ifset
2032
2033 On some platforms the @option{--relax} option performs target specific,
2034 global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
2035 addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
2036 synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
2037 instructions, and combining constant values.
2038
2039 On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic
2040 debugging of the resulting executable impossible.
2041 @ifset GENERIC
2042 This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
2043 family of processors.
2044 @end ifset
2045
2046 On platforms where the feature is supported, the option
2047 @option{--no-relax} will disable it.
2048
2049 On platforms where the feature is not supported, both @option{--relax}
2050 and @option{--no-relax} are accepted, but ignored.
2051
2052 @cindex retaining specified symbols
2053 @cindex stripping all but some symbols
2054 @cindex symbols, retaining selectively
2055 @kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2056 @item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2057 Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename},
2058 discarding all others. @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one
2059 symbol name per line. This option is especially useful in environments
2060 @ifset GENERIC
2061 (such as VxWorks)
2062 @end ifset
2063 where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve
2064 run-time memory.
2065
2066 @samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols,
2067 or symbols needed for relocations.
2068
2069 You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command
2070 line. It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}.
2071
2072 @ifset GENERIC
2073 @item -rpath=@var{dir}
2074 @cindex runtime library search path
2075 @kindex -rpath=@var{dir}
2076 Add a directory to the runtime library search path. This is used when
2077 linking an ELF executable with shared objects. All @option{-rpath}
2078 arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses
2079 them to locate shared objects at runtime.
2080
2081 The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which
2082 are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
2083 description of the @option{-rpath-link} option. Searching @option{-rpath}
2084 in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which
2085 have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2086
2087 If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the
2088 contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it
2089 is defined.
2090
2091 The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS. By default, on
2092 SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the
2093 @option{-L} options it is given. If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the
2094 runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath}
2095 options, ignoring the @option{-L} options. This can be useful when using
2096 gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted
2097 file systems.
2098
2099 For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
2100 followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
2101 the @option{-rpath} option.
2102 @end ifset
2103
2104 @ifset GENERIC
2105 @cindex link-time runtime library search path
2106 @kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2107 @item -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2108 When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another. This
2109 happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one
2110 of the input files.
2111
2112 When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared,
2113 non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required
2114 shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included
2115 explicitly. In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option
2116 specifies the first set of directories to search. The
2117 @option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names
2118 either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
2119 appearing multiple times.
2120
2121 The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search
2122 directories. They will be replaced by the full path to the directory
2123 containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN}
2124 and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for
2125 64-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}.
2126
2127 The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and
2128 @var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used. The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not
2129 supported.
2130
2131 This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path
2132 that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it
2133 is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the
2134 runtime linker would do.
2135
2136 The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared
2137 libraries:
2138
2139 @enumerate
2140 @item
2141 Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options.
2142 @item
2143 Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options. The difference
2144 between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories
2145 specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and
2146 used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective
2147 at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported
2148 by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with
2149 the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2150 @item
2151 On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and
2152 @option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the
2153 environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}.
2154 @item
2155 On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any
2156 directories specified using @option{-L} options.
2157 @item
2158 For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
2159 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}.
2160 @item
2161 For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or
2162 @code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared
2163 libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if
2164 @code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist.
2165 @item
2166 The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}.
2167 @item
2168 For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf}
2169 exists, the list of directories found in that file. Note: the path
2170 to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is
2171 defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was
2172 configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option.
2173 @item
2174 For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by
2175 the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h}
2176 header file.
2177 @item
2178 Any directories specifed by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in the
2179 linker script being used.
2180 @end enumerate
2181
2182 If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a
2183 warning and continue with the link.
2184 @end ifset
2185
2186 @kindex -shared
2187 @kindex -Bshareable
2188 @item -shared
2189 @itemx -Bshareable
2190 @cindex shared libraries
2191 Create a shared library. This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF
2192 and SunOS platforms. On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a
2193 shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are
2194 undefined symbols in the link.
2195
2196 @kindex --sort-common
2197 @item --sort-common
2198 @itemx --sort-common=ascending
2199 @itemx --sort-common=descending
2200 This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in
2201 ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output
2202 sections. The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger,
2203 eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps
2204 between symbols due to alignment constraints. If no sorting order is
2205 specified, then descending order is assumed.
2206
2207 @kindex --sort-section=name
2208 @item --sort-section=name
2209 This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section
2210 patterns in the linker script.
2211
2212 @kindex --sort-section=alignment
2213 @item --sort-section=alignment
2214 This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section
2215 patterns in the linker script.
2216
2217 @kindex --spare-dynamic-tags
2218 @item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count}
2219 This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the
2220 .dynamic section of ELF shared objects. Empty slots may be needed by
2221 post processing tools, such as the prelinker. The default is 5.
2222
2223 @kindex --split-by-file
2224 @item --split-by-file[=@var{size}]
2225 Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for
2226 each input file when @var{size} is reached. @var{size} defaults to a
2227 size of 1 if not given.
2228
2229 @kindex --split-by-reloc
2230 @item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}]
2231 Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single
2232 output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations.
2233 This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into
2234 certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF
2235 cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section. Note
2236 that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not
2237 support arbitrary sections. The linker will not split up individual
2238 input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains
2239 more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that
2240 many relocations. @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768.
2241
2242 @kindex --stats
2243 @item --stats
2244 Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such
2245 as execution time and memory usage.
2246
2247 @kindex --sysroot=@var{directory}
2248 @item --sysroot=@var{directory}
2249 Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
2250 configure-time default. This option is only supported by linkers
2251 that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}.
2252
2253 @kindex --task-link
2254 @item --task-link
2255 This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object
2256 file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics.
2257
2258 @kindex --traditional-format
2259 @cindex traditional format
2260 @item --traditional-format
2261 For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from
2262 the output of some existing linker. This switch requests @command{ld} to
2263 use the traditional format instead.
2264
2265 @cindex dbx
2266 For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the
2267 symbol string table. This can reduce the size of an output file with
2268 full debugging information by over 30 percent. Unfortunately, the SunOS
2269 @code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no
2270 trouble). The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not
2271 combine duplicate entries.
2272
2273 @kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2274 @item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2275 Locate a section in the output file at the absolute
2276 address given by @var{org}. You may use this option as many
2277 times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command
2278 line.
2279 @var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer;
2280 for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading
2281 @samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values. @emph{Note:} there
2282 should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals
2283 sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}.
2284
2285 @kindex -Tbss=@var{org}
2286 @kindex -Tdata=@var{org}
2287 @kindex -Ttext=@var{org}
2288 @cindex segment origins, cmd line
2289 @item -Tbss=@var{org}
2290 @itemx -Tdata=@var{org}
2291 @itemx -Ttext=@var{org}
2292 Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or
2293 @code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}.
2294
2295 @kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2296 @item -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2297 @cindex text segment origin, cmd line
2298 When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first
2299 byte of the text segment.
2300
2301 @kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2302 @item -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2303 @cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line
2304 When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
2305 the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable
2306 text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment.
2307
2308 @kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2309 @item -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2310 @cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line
2311 When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory
2312 model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment.
2313
2314 @kindex --unresolved-symbols
2315 @item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method}
2316 Determine how to handle unresolved symbols. There are four possible
2317 values for @samp{method}:
2318
2319 @table @samp
2320 @item ignore-all
2321 Do not report any unresolved symbols.
2322
2323 @item report-all
2324 Report all unresolved symbols. This is the default.
2325
2326 @item ignore-in-object-files
2327 Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but
2328 ignore them if they come from regular object files.
2329
2330 @item ignore-in-shared-libs
2331 Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but
2332 ignore them if they come from shared libraries. This can be useful
2333 when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared
2334 libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's
2335 command line.
2336 @end table
2337
2338 The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled
2339 by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option.
2340
2341 Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported
2342 unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols}
2343 can change this to a warning.
2344
2345 @kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2346 @cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2347 @item --dll-verbose
2348 @itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2349 Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations
2350 supported. Display which input files can and cannot be opened. Display
2351 the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER}
2352 argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed.
2353
2354 @kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2355 @cindex version script, symbol versions
2356 @item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2357 Specify the name of a version script to the linker. This is typically
2358 used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information
2359 about the version hierarchy for the library being created. This option
2360 is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries;
2361 see @ref{VERSION}. It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can
2362 use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
2363 symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported.
2364 @xref{WIN32}.
2365
2366 @kindex --warn-common
2367 @cindex warnings, on combining symbols
2368 @cindex combining symbols, warnings on
2369 @item --warn-common
2370 Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with
2371 a symbol definition. Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice,
2372 but linkers on some other operating systems do not. This option allows
2373 you to find potential problems from combining global symbols.
2374 Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some
2375 warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs.
2376
2377 There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples:
2378
2379 @table @samp
2380 @item int i = 1;
2381 A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output
2382 file.
2383
2384 @item extern int i;
2385 An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.
2386 There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
2387 variable somewhere.
2388
2389 @item int i;
2390 A common symbol. If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a
2391 variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file.
2392 The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a
2393 single symbol. If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest
2394 size. The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
2395 a definition of the same variable.
2396 @end table
2397
2398 The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings.
2399 Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol
2400 just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol
2401 encountered with the same name. One or both of the two symbols will be
2402 a common symbol.
2403
2404 @enumerate
2405 @item
2406 Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a
2407 definition for the symbol.
2408 @smallexample
2409 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2410 overridden by definition
2411 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here
2412 @end smallexample
2413
2414 @item
2415 Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for
2416 the symbol is encountered. This is the same as the previous case,
2417 except that the symbols are encountered in a different order.
2418 @smallexample
2419 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}'
2420 overriding common
2421 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here
2422 @end smallexample
2423
2424 @item
2425 Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol.
2426 @smallexample
2427 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common
2428 of `@var{symbol}'
2429 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here
2430 @end smallexample
2431
2432 @item
2433 Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
2434 @smallexample
2435 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2436 overridden by larger common
2437 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here
2438 @end smallexample
2439
2440 @item
2441 Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol. This is
2442 the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are
2443 encountered in a different order.
2444 @smallexample
2445 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2446 overriding smaller common
2447 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here
2448 @end smallexample
2449 @end enumerate
2450
2451 @kindex --warn-constructors
2452 @item --warn-constructors
2453 Warn if any global constructors are used. This is only useful for a few
2454 object file formats. For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not
2455 detect the use of global constructors.
2456
2457 @kindex --warn-multiple-gp
2458 @item --warn-multiple-gp
2459 Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file.
2460 This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha.
2461 Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special
2462 section. A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle
2463 of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a
2464 base-register relative addressing mode. Since the offset in
2465 base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16
2466 bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool. Thus, in
2467 large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer
2468 values in order to be able to address all possible constants. This
2469 option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs.
2470
2471 @kindex --warn-once
2472 @cindex warnings, on undefined symbols
2473 @cindex undefined symbols, warnings on
2474 @item --warn-once
2475 Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module
2476 which refers to it.
2477
2478 @kindex --warn-section-align
2479 @cindex warnings, on section alignment
2480 @cindex section alignment, warnings on
2481 @item --warn-section-align
2482 Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
2483 alignment. Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section.
2484 The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that
2485 is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for
2486 the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}).
2487
2488 @kindex --warn-textrel
2489 @item --warn-textrel
2490 Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable
2491 or shared object.
2492
2493 @kindex --warn-alternate-em
2494 @item --warn-alternate-em
2495 Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
2496
2497 @kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols
2498 @item --warn-unresolved-symbols
2499 If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option
2500 @option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error.
2501 This option makes it generate a warning instead.
2502
2503 @kindex --error-unresolved-symbols
2504 @item --error-unresolved-symbols
2505 This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when
2506 it is reporting unresolved symbols.
2507
2508 @kindex --whole-archive
2509 @cindex including an entire archive
2510 @item --whole-archive
2511 For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
2512 @option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive
2513 in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object
2514 files. This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared
2515 library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared
2516 library. This option may be used more than once.
2517
2518 Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
2519 about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}.
2520 Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your
2521 list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
2522 your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
2523
2524 @kindex --wrap=@var{symbol}
2525 @item --wrap=@var{symbol}
2526 Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}. Any undefined reference to
2527 @var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. Any
2528 undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to
2529 @var{symbol}.
2530
2531 This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function. The
2532 wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. If it
2533 wishes to call the system function, it should call
2534 @code{__real_@var{symbol}}.
2535
2536 Here is a trivial example:
2537
2538 @smallexample
2539 void *
2540 __wrap_malloc (size_t c)
2541 @{
2542 printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
2543 return __real_malloc (c);
2544 @}
2545 @end smallexample
2546
2547 If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then
2548 all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc}
2549 instead. The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will
2550 call the real @code{malloc} function.
2551
2552 You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that
2553 links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed. If you do this,
2554 you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same
2555 file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
2556 call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}.
2557
2558 Only undefined references are replaced by the linker. So, translation unit
2559 internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to
2560 @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. In the next example, the call to @code{f} in
2561 @code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}.
2562
2563 @smallexample
2564 int
2565 f (void)
2566 @{
2567 return 123;
2568 @}
2569
2570 int
2571 g (void)
2572 @{
2573 return f();
2574 @}
2575 @end smallexample
2576
2577 @kindex --eh-frame-hdr
2578 @kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr
2579 @item --eh-frame-hdr
2580 @itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr
2581 Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress
2582 (@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr}
2583 section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header.
2584
2585 @kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info
2586 @item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info
2587 Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker
2588 generated code sections like PLT. This option is on by default
2589 if linker generated unwind info is supported.
2590
2591 @kindex --enable-new-dtags
2592 @kindex --disable-new-dtags
2593 @item --enable-new-dtags
2594 @itemx --disable-new-dtags
2595 This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF
2596 systems may not understand them. If you specify
2597 @option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed
2598 and older dynamic tags will be omitted.
2599 If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be
2600 created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that
2601 those options are only available for ELF systems.
2602
2603 @kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
2604 @item --hash-size=@var{number}
2605 Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
2606 close to @var{number}. Increasing this value can reduce the length of
2607 time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
2608 increasing the linker's memory requirements. Similarly reducing this
2609 value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed.
2610
2611 @kindex --hash-style=@var{style}
2612 @item --hash-style=@var{style}
2613 Set the type of linker's hash table(s). @var{style} can be either
2614 @code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for
2615 new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both
2616 the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash}
2617 hash tables. The default depends upon how the linker was configured,
2618 but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}.
2619
2620 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=none
2621 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2622 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2623 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2624 @item --compress-debug-sections=none
2625 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2626 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2627 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2628 On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are
2629 compressed using zlib.
2630
2631 @option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug
2632 sections. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses
2633 DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug}
2634 instead of @samp{.debug}. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}
2635 also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it
2636 sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers.
2637
2638 The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for
2639 @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}.
2640
2641 Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug
2642 sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none}
2643 for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be
2644 uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary.
2645
2646 The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target
2647 involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain. The
2648 default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's
2649 @option{--help} option.
2650
2651 @kindex --reduce-memory-overheads
2652 @item --reduce-memory-overheads
2653 This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of
2654 linking speed. This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm
2655 for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses
2656 about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
2657
2658 Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to
2659 1021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's
2660 run time. This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch
2661 has been used.
2662
2663 The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to
2664 enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
2665
2666 @kindex --build-id
2667 @kindex --build-id=@var{style}
2668 @item --build-id
2669 @itemx --build-id=@var{style}
2670 Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section
2671 or a @code{.buildid} COFF section. The contents of the note are
2672 unique bits identifying this linked file. @var{style} can be
2673 @code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit
2674 @sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents,
2675 @code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of
2676 the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit
2677 string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and
2678 @code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored). If @var{style}
2679 is omitted, @code{sha1} is used.
2680
2681 The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier
2682 that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be
2683 unique among all nonidentical output files. It is not intended
2684 to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents. A linked
2685 file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit
2686 string identifying the original linked file does not change.
2687
2688 Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any
2689 @code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line.
2690 @end table
2691
2692 @c man end
2693
2694 @subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
2695
2696 @c man begin OPTIONS
2697
2698 The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes
2699 the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a
2700 normal executable. You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you
2701 use this option. In addition, the linker fully supports the standard
2702 @code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line
2703 like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports
2704 symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal
2705 object file).
2706
2707 In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
2708 support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386
2709 PE target. Options that take values may be separated from their
2710 values by either a space or an equals sign.
2711
2712 @table @gcctabopt
2713
2714 @kindex --add-stdcall-alias
2715 @item --add-stdcall-alias
2716 If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported
2717 as-is and also with the suffix stripped.
2718 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2719
2720 @kindex --base-file
2721 @item --base-file @var{file}
2722 Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base
2723 addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with
2724 @file{dlltool}.
2725 [This is an i386 PE specific option]
2726
2727 @kindex --dll
2728 @item --dll
2729 Create a DLL instead of a regular executable. You may also use
2730 @option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def}
2731 file.
2732 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2733
2734 @kindex --enable-long-section-names
2735 @kindex --disable-long-section-names
2736 @item --enable-long-section-names
2737 @itemx --disable-long-section-names
2738 The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits
2739 the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit
2740 for COFF. By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as
2741 fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required
2742 to support the longer names. As a GNU extension, it is possible to
2743 allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)
2744 disallow it in object files, by using these two options. Executable images
2745 generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying
2746 as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined
2747 with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers. However,
2748 GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug
2749 information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither
2750 option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long
2751 section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour,
2752 when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
2753 image and not stripping symbols.
2754 [This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker]
2755
2756 @kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup
2757 @kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup
2758 @item --enable-stdcall-fixup
2759 @itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup
2760 If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to
2761 do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs
2762 only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will
2763 resolve that symbol by linking to the match. For example, the
2764 undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function
2765 @code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked
2766 to the function @code{_bar}. When the linker does this, it prints a
2767 warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes
2768 import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature
2769 to be usable. If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this
2770 feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed. If you specify
2771 @option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such
2772 mismatches are considered to be errors.
2773 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2774
2775 @kindex --leading-underscore
2776 @kindex --no-leading-underscore
2777 @item --leading-underscore
2778 @itemx --no-leading-underscore
2779 For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined
2780 in target's description. By this option it is possible to
2781 disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
2782
2783 @cindex DLLs, creating
2784 @kindex --export-all-symbols
2785 @item --export-all-symbols
2786 If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will
2787 be exported by the DLL. Note that this is the default if there
2788 otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols. When symbols are
2789 explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function
2790 attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this
2791 option is given. Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12},
2792 @code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and
2793 @code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically
2794 exported. Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be
2795 re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout
2796 such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with
2797 @code{_iname}. In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc},
2798 @code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported.
2799 Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will
2800 not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs. Finally, there is an
2801 extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported
2802 (obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).
2803 These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12},
2804 @code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12},
2805 @code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll},
2806 @code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2},
2807 @code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}.
2808 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2809
2810 @kindex --exclude-symbols
2811 @item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},...
2812 Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
2813 exported. The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
2814 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2815
2816 @kindex --exclude-all-symbols
2817 @item --exclude-all-symbols
2818 Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.
2819 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2820
2821 @kindex --file-alignment
2822 @item --file-alignment
2823 Specify the file alignment. Sections in the file will always begin at
2824 file offsets which are multiples of this number. This defaults to
2825 512.
2826 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2827
2828 @cindex heap size
2829 @kindex --heap
2830 @item --heap @var{reserve}
2831 @itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit}
2832 Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
2833 to be used as heap for this program. The default is 1MB reserved, 4K
2834 committed.
2835 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2836
2837 @cindex image base
2838 @kindex --image-base
2839 @item --image-base @var{value}
2840 Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll. This is
2841 the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
2842 is loaded. To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of
2843 your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any
2844 other dlls. The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000
2845 for dlls.
2846 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2847
2848 @kindex --kill-at
2849 @item --kill-at
2850 If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from
2851 symbols before they are exported.
2852 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2853
2854 @kindex --large-address-aware
2855 @item --large-address-aware
2856 If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF
2857 header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses
2858 greater than 2 gigabytes. This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB
2859 or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]''
2860 section of the BOOT.INI. Otherwise, this bit has no effect.
2861 [This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
2862
2863 @kindex --disable-large-address-aware
2864 @item --disable-large-address-aware
2865 Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option.
2866 This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler
2867 driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual
2868 addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.
2869 [This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
2870
2871 @kindex --major-image-version
2872 @item --major-image-version @var{value}
2873 Sets the major number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 1.
2874 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2875
2876 @kindex --major-os-version
2877 @item --major-os-version @var{value}
2878 Sets the major number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 4.
2879 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2880
2881 @kindex --major-subsystem-version
2882 @item --major-subsystem-version @var{value}
2883 Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 4.
2884 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2885
2886 @kindex --minor-image-version
2887 @item --minor-image-version @var{value}
2888 Sets the minor number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 0.
2889 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2890
2891 @kindex --minor-os-version
2892 @item --minor-os-version @var{value}
2893 Sets the minor number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 0.
2894 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2895
2896 @kindex --minor-subsystem-version
2897 @item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value}
2898 Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 0.
2899 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2900
2901 @cindex DEF files, creating
2902 @cindex DLLs, creating
2903 @kindex --output-def
2904 @item --output-def @var{file}
2905 The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF
2906 file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating. This DEF file
2907 (which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import
2908 library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to
2909 automatically or implicitly exported symbols.
2910 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2911
2912 @cindex DLLs, creating
2913 @kindex --enable-auto-image-base
2914 @item --enable-auto-image-base
2915 @itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value}
2916 Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base
2917 @var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument.
2918 By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases
2919 for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program
2920 execution are avoided.
2921 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2922
2923 @kindex --disable-auto-image-base
2924 @item --disable-auto-image-base
2925 Do not automatically generate a unique image base. If there is no
2926 user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform
2927 default.
2928 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2929
2930 @cindex DLLs, linking to
2931 @kindex --dll-search-prefix
2932 @item --dll-search-prefix @var{string}
2933 When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
2934 search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to
2935 @code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction
2936 between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
2937 uwin, pw, etc. For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
2938 @code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}.
2939 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2940
2941 @kindex --enable-auto-import
2942 @item --enable-auto-import
2943 Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for
2944 DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport
2945 mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names.
2946 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2947
2948 The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the
2949 feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
2950
2951 Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section
2952 of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
2953 PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
2954
2955 Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
2956 data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
2957 placed into the .data section instead. This is in order to work
2958 around a problem with consts that is described here:
2959 http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
2960
2961 Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may
2962 see this message:
2963
2964 "variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
2965 documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
2966
2967 This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
2968 ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only
2969 allow one). Instances where this may occur include accesses to member
2970 fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a
2971 constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL. Any
2972 multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger
2973 this error condition. However, regardless of the exact data type
2974 of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue
2975 the warning, and exit.
2976
2977 There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the
2978 data type of the exported variable:
2979
2980 One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task
2981 of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so
2982 this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature.
2983
2984 A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable --
2985 that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time. For arrays,
2986 there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address)
2987 a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable. Thus:
2988
2989 @example
2990 extern type extern_array[];
2991 extern_array[1] -->
2992 @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @}
2993 @end example
2994
2995 or
2996
2997 @example
2998 extern type extern_array[];
2999 extern_array[1] -->
3000 @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @}
3001 @end example
3002
3003 For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
3004 is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable:
3005
3006 @example
3007 extern struct s extern_struct;
3008 extern_struct.field -->
3009 @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @}
3010 @end example
3011
3012 or
3013
3014 @example
3015 extern long long extern_ll;
3016 extern_ll -->
3017 @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @}
3018 @end example
3019
3020 A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
3021 'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
3022 @code{__declspec(dllimport)}. However, in practice that
3023 requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are
3024 building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or
3025 merely building/linking to a static library. In making the choice
3026 between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
3027 constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage:
3028
3029 Original:
3030 @example
3031 --foo.h
3032 extern int arr[];
3033 --foo.c
3034 #include "foo.h"
3035 void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3036 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3037 @}
3038 @end example
3039
3040 Solution 1:
3041 @example
3042 --foo.h
3043 extern int arr[];
3044 --foo.c
3045 #include "foo.h"
3046 void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3047 /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
3048 volatile int *parr = arr;
3049 printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
3050 @}
3051 @end example
3052
3053 Solution 2:
3054 @example
3055 --foo.h
3056 /* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
3057 #if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
3058 !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
3059 #define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
3060 #else
3061 #define FOO_IMPORT
3062 #endif
3063 extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
3064 --foo.c
3065 #include "foo.h"
3066 void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3067 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3068 @}
3069 @end example
3070
3071 A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your
3072 library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface
3073 for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
3074 functions).
3075
3076 @kindex --disable-auto-import
3077 @item --disable-auto-import
3078 Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to
3079 @code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs.
3080 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3081
3082 @kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3083 @item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3084 If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section,
3085 that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create
3086 a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime
3087 environment to adjust references to such data in your client code.
3088 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3089
3090 @kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3091 @item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3092 Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs.
3093 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3094
3095 @kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug
3096 @item --enable-extra-pe-debug
3097 Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
3098 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3099
3100 @kindex --section-alignment
3101 @item --section-alignment
3102 Sets the section alignment. Sections in memory will always begin at
3103 addresses which are a multiple of this number. Defaults to 0x1000.
3104 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3105
3106 @cindex stack size
3107 @kindex --stack
3108 @item --stack @var{reserve}
3109 @itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit}
3110 Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
3111 to be used as stack for this program. The default is 2MB reserved, 4K
3112 committed.
3113 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3114
3115 @kindex --subsystem
3116 @item --subsystem @var{which}
3117 @itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}
3118 @itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor}
3119 Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute. The
3120 legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows},
3121 @code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}. You may optionally set
3122 the subsystem version also. Numeric values are also accepted for
3123 @var{which}.
3124 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3125
3126 The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field
3127 of the PE file header:
3128 [These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3129
3130 @kindex --high-entropy-va
3131 @item --high-entropy-va
3132 @itemx --disable-high-entropy-va
3133 Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
3134 (ASLR). This option is enabled by default for 64-bit PE images.
3135
3136 This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and
3137 @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
3138
3139 @kindex --dynamicbase
3140 @item --dynamicbase
3141 @itemx --disable-dynamicbase
3142 The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
3143 randomization (ASLR). This feature was introduced with MS Windows
3144 Vista for i386 PE targets. This option is enabled by default but
3145 can be disabled via the @option{--disable-dynamicbase} option.
3146 This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
3147
3148 @kindex --forceinteg
3149 @item --forceinteg
3150 @itemx --disable-forceinteg
3151 Code integrity checks are enforced. This option is disabled by
3152 default.
3153
3154 @kindex --nxcompat
3155 @item --nxcompat
3156 @item --disable-nxcompat
3157 The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.
3158 This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE
3159 targets. The option is enabled by default.
3160
3161 @kindex --no-isolation
3162 @item --no-isolation
3163 @itemx --disable-no-isolation
3164 Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
3165 This option is disabled by default.
3166
3167 @kindex --no-seh
3168 @item --no-seh
3169 @itemx --disable-no-seh
3170 The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from
3171 this image. This option is disabled by default.
3172
3173 @kindex --no-bind
3174 @item --no-bind
3175 @itemx --disable-no-bind
3176 Do not bind this image. This option is disabled by default.
3177
3178 @kindex --wdmdriver
3179 @item --wdmdriver
3180 @itemx --disable-wdmdriver
3181 The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model. This option is disabled
3182 by default.
3183
3184 @kindex --tsaware
3185 @item --tsaware
3186 @itemx --disable-tsaware
3187 The image is Terminal Server aware. This option is disabled by
3188 default.
3189
3190 @kindex --insert-timestamp
3191 @item --insert-timestamp
3192 @itemx --no-insert-timestamp
3193 Insert a real timestamp into the image. This is the default behaviour
3194 as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with
3195 other, proprietary tools. The problem with this default is that it
3196 will result in slightly different images being produced each time the
3197 same sources are linked. The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp}
3198 can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring
3199 that binaries produced from identical sources will compare
3200 identically.
3201
3202 @kindex --enable-reloc-section
3203 @item --enable-reloc-section
3204 @itemx --disable-reloc-section
3205 Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image
3206 is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header.
3207 This option is enabled by default.
3208 @end table
3209
3210 @c man end
3211
3212 @ifset C6X
3213 @subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
3214
3215 @c man begin OPTIONS
3216
3217 The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared
3218 libraries. Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index;
3219 all executables use an index of 0.
3220
3221 @table @gcctabopt
3222
3223 @kindex --dsbt-size
3224 @item --dsbt-size @var{size}
3225 This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable
3226 or shared library to @var{size}. The default is to create a table with 64
3227 entries.
3228
3229 @kindex --dsbt-index
3230 @item --dsbt-index @var{index}
3231 This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library
3232 to @var{index}. The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating
3233 executables. If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the
3234 @code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file.
3235
3236 @kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
3237 The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent
3238 exidx entries in frame unwind info.
3239
3240 @end table
3241
3242 @c man end
3243 @end ifset
3244
3245 @ifset CSKY
3246 @subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets
3247
3248 @c man begin OPTIONS
3249
3250 @table @gcctabopt
3251
3252 @kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY
3253 @item --branch-stub
3254 This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub
3255 sections when needed to extend the range of branches. This option is
3256 usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that
3257 can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by
3258 the compiler or assembler.
3259
3260 @kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY
3261 @item --stub-group-size=@var{N}
3262 This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation.
3263 It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can
3264 be handled by one stub section. A negative value of @var{N} locates
3265 stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub
3266 sections to appear either before or after the branches. Values of
3267 @samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the
3268 linker should choose suitable defaults.
3269
3270 @end table
3271
3272 @c man end
3273 @end ifset
3274
3275 @ifset M68HC11
3276 @subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
3277
3278 @c man begin OPTIONS
3279
3280 The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
3281 memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
3282
3283 @table @gcctabopt
3284
3285 @kindex --no-trampoline
3286 @item --no-trampoline
3287 This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline
3288 is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr}
3289 instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken).
3290
3291 @kindex --bank-window
3292 @item --bank-window @var{name}
3293 This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in
3294 the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window.
3295 The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute
3296 paging and addresses within the memory window.
3297
3298 @end table
3299
3300 @c man end
3301 @end ifset
3302
3303 @ifset M68K
3304 @subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target
3305
3306 @c man begin OPTIONS
3307
3308 The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation
3309 when linking for 68K targets.
3310
3311 @table @gcctabopt
3312
3313 @kindex --got
3314 @item --got=@var{type}
3315 This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
3316 @var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative},
3317 @samp{multigot} or @samp{target}. For more information refer to the
3318 Info entry for @file{ld}.
3319
3320 @end table
3321
3322 @c man end
3323 @end ifset
3324
3325 @ifset MIPS
3326 @subsection Options specific to MIPS targets
3327
3328 @c man begin OPTIONS
3329
3330 The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
3331 generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when
3332 linking for MIPS targets.
3333
3334 @table @gcctabopt
3335
3336 @kindex --insn32
3337 @item --insn32
3338 @kindex --no-insn32
3339 @itemx --no-insn32
3340 These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code
3341 generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs,
3342 or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses
3343 32-bit instruction encodings. By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is
3344 used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where
3345 possible.
3346
3347 @kindex --ignore-branch-isa
3348 @item --ignore-branch-isa
3349 @kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
3350 @itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa
3351 These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode
3352 transitions. If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker
3353 accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required
3354 is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL}
3355 instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to
3356 equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is
3357 calculated. By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used
3358 a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce
3359 an error.
3360
3361 @kindex --compact-branches
3362 @item --compact-branches
3363 @kindex --no-compact-branches
3364 @itemx --no-compact-branches
3365 These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker
3366 in the PLT entries for MIPS R6.
3367
3368 @end table
3369
3370 @c man end
3371 @end ifset
3372
3373
3374 @ifset PDP11
3375 @subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets
3376
3377 @c man begin OPTIONS
3378
3379 For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be
3380 produced as selected by the following options. The default variant
3381 for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other
3382 targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default. The @samp{--imagic} option is
3383 defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described
3384 here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target.
3385
3386 @table @gcctabopt
3387
3388 @kindex -N
3389 @item -N
3390 @kindex --omagic
3391 @itemx --omagic
3392
3393 Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to
3394 indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and
3395 shared. Since the text and data sections are both readable and
3396 writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after
3397 the text segment. This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable
3398 programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems
3399 from the beginning through 2.11BSD.
3400
3401 @kindex -n
3402 @item -n
3403 @kindex --nmagic
3404 @itemx --nmagic
3405
3406 Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to
3407 indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will
3408 be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same
3409 file. This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K
3410 byte page boundary following the end of the text. This option creates
3411 a @emph{pure executable} format.
3412
3413 @kindex -z
3414 @item -z
3415 @kindex --imagic
3416 @itemx --imagic
3417
3418 Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to
3419 indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and
3420 data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split
3421 instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in
3422 larger models of the PDP11. This doubles the address space available
3423 to the program. The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and
3424 shareable. The only difference in the output format between this
3425 option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text
3426 and data sections start at location 0. The @samp{-z} option selected
3427 this format in 2.11BSD. This option creates a @emph{separate
3428 executable} format.
3429
3430 @kindex --no-omagic
3431 @item --no-omagic
3432
3433 Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout.
3434
3435 @end table
3436
3437 @c man end
3438 @end ifset
3439
3440 @ifset UsesEnvVars
3441 @node Environment
3442 @section Environment Variables
3443
3444 @c man begin ENVIRONMENT
3445
3446 You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables
3447 @ifclear SingleFormat
3448 @code{GNUTARGET},
3449 @end ifclear
3450 @code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}.
3451
3452 @ifclear SingleFormat
3453 @kindex GNUTARGET
3454 @cindex default input format
3455 @code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't
3456 use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}). Its value should be one
3457 of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}). If there is no
3458 @code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format
3459 of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD
3460 attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files;
3461 this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since
3462 there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify
3463 object-file formats is unique. However, the configuration procedure for
3464 BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first
3465 in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
3466 @end ifclear
3467
3468 @kindex LDEMULATION
3469 @cindex default emulation
3470 @cindex emulation, default
3471 @code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the
3472 @samp{-m} option. The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
3473 behaviour, particularly the default linker script. You can list the
3474 available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options. If
3475 the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment
3476 variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the
3477 linker was configured.
3478
3479 @kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE
3480 @cindex demangling, default
3481 Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols. However, if
3482 @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will
3483 default to not demangling symbols. This environment variable is used in
3484 a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program. The default
3485 may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle}
3486 options.
3487
3488 @c man end
3489 @end ifset
3490
3491 @node Scripts
3492 @chapter Linker Scripts
3493
3494 @cindex scripts
3495 @cindex linker scripts
3496 @cindex command files
3497 Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}. This script is
3498 written in the linker command language.
3499
3500 The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in
3501 the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control
3502 the memory layout of the output file. Most linker scripts do nothing
3503 more than this. However, when necessary, the linker script can also
3504 direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands
3505 described below.
3506
3507 The linker always uses a linker script. If you do not supply one
3508 yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
3509 linker executable. You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option
3510 to display the default linker script. Certain command-line options,
3511 such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script.
3512
3513 You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command
3514 line option. When you do this, your linker script will replace the
3515 default linker script.
3516
3517 You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files
3518 to the linker, as though they were files to be linked. @xref{Implicit
3519 Linker Scripts}.
3520
3521 @menu
3522 * Basic Script Concepts:: Basic Linker Script Concepts
3523 * Script Format:: Linker Script Format
3524 * Simple Example:: Simple Linker Script Example
3525 * Simple Commands:: Simple Linker Script Commands
3526 * Assignments:: Assigning Values to Symbols
3527 * SECTIONS:: SECTIONS Command
3528 * MEMORY:: MEMORY Command
3529 * PHDRS:: PHDRS Command
3530 * VERSION:: VERSION Command
3531 * Expressions:: Expressions in Linker Scripts
3532 * Implicit Linker Scripts:: Implicit Linker Scripts
3533 @end menu
3534
3535 @node Basic Script Concepts
3536 @section Basic Linker Script Concepts
3537 @cindex linker script concepts
3538 We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
3539 describe the linker script language.
3540
3541 The linker combines input files into a single output file. The output
3542 file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
3543 @dfn{object file format}. Each file is called an @dfn{object file}.
3544 The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our
3545 purposes we will also call it an object file. Each object file has,
3546 among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}. We sometimes refer to a
3547 section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section
3548 in the output file is an @dfn{output section}.
3549
3550 Each section in an object file has a name and a size. Most sections
3551 also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section
3552 contents}. A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that
3553 the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.
3554 A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an
3555 area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be
3556 loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out). A section
3557 which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort
3558 of debugging information.
3559
3560 Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses. The
3561 first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address. This is the address
3562 the section will have when the output file is run. The second is the
3563 @dfn{LMA}, or load memory address. This is the address at which the
3564 section will be loaded. In most cases the two addresses will be the
3565 same. An example of when they might be different is when a data section
3566 is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
3567 (this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
3568 based system). In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
3569 RAM address would be the VMA.
3570
3571 You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump}
3572 program with the @samp{-h} option.
3573
3574 Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the
3575 @dfn{symbol table}. A symbol may be defined or undefined. Each symbol
3576 has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other
3577 information. If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you
3578 will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or
3579 static variable. Every undefined function or global variable which is
3580 referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
3581
3582 You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm}
3583 program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t}
3584 option.
3585
3586 @node Script Format
3587 @section Linker Script Format
3588 @cindex linker script format
3589 Linker scripts are text files.
3590
3591 You write a linker script as a series of commands. Each command is
3592 either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
3593 symbol. You may separate commands using semicolons. Whitespace is
3594 generally ignored.
3595
3596 Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly.
3597 If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would
3598 otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in
3599 double quotes. There is no way to use a double quote character in a
3600 file name.
3601
3602 You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
3603 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/}. As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent
3604 to whitespace.
3605
3606 @node Simple Example
3607 @section Simple Linker Script Example
3608 @cindex linker script example
3609 @cindex example of linker script
3610 Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
3611
3612 The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
3613 @samp{SECTIONS}. You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the
3614 memory layout of the output file.
3615
3616 The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command. Here we will
3617 describe a simple use of it. Let's assume your program consists only of
3618 code, initialized data, and uninitialized data. These will be in the
3619 @samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively.
3620 Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in
3621 your input files.
3622
3623 For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
3624 0x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000. Here is a
3625 linker script which will do that:
3626 @smallexample
3627 SECTIONS
3628 @{
3629 . = 0x10000;
3630 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
3631 . = 0x8000000;
3632 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
3633 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
3634 @}
3635 @end smallexample
3636
3637 You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS},
3638 followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section
3639 descriptions enclosed in curly braces.
3640
3641 The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example
3642 sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location
3643 counter. If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
3644 other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
3645 current value of the location counter. The location counter is then
3646 incremented by the size of the output section. At the start of the
3647 @samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}.
3648
3649 The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}. The colon is
3650 required syntax which may be ignored for now. Within the curly braces
3651 after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
3652 which should be placed into this output section. The @samp{*} is a
3653 wildcard which matches any file name. The expression @samp{*(.text)}
3654 means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files.
3655
3656 Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section
3657 @samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the
3658 @samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}.
3659
3660 The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in
3661 the output file. The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section
3662 at address @samp{0x8000000}. After the linker places the @samp{.data}
3663 output section, the value of the location counter will be
3664 @samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section. The
3665 effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section
3666 immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory.
3667
3668 The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
3669 alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary. In this
3670 example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}
3671 sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker
3672 may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss}
3673 sections.
3674
3675 That's it! That's a simple and complete linker script.
3676
3677 @node Simple Commands
3678 @section Simple Linker Script Commands
3679 @cindex linker script simple commands
3680 In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
3681
3682 @menu
3683 * Entry Point:: Setting the entry point
3684 * File Commands:: Commands dealing with files
3685 @ifclear SingleFormat
3686 * Format Commands:: Commands dealing with object file formats
3687 @end ifclear
3688
3689 * REGION_ALIAS:: Assign alias names to memory regions
3690 * Miscellaneous Commands:: Other linker script commands
3691 @end menu
3692
3693 @node Entry Point
3694 @subsection Setting the Entry Point
3695 @kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3696 @cindex start of execution
3697 @cindex first instruction
3698 @cindex entry point
3699 The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry
3700 point}. You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the
3701 entry point. The argument is a symbol name:
3702 @smallexample
3703 ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3704 @end smallexample
3705
3706 There are several ways to set the entry point. The linker will set the
3707 entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
3708 stopping when one of them succeeds:
3709 @itemize @bullet
3710 @item
3711 the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option;
3712 @item
3713 the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script;
3714 @item
3715 the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined; For many
3716 targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example
3717 check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found.
3718 @item
3719 the address of the first byte of the @samp{.text} section, if present;
3720 @item
3721 The address @code{0}.
3722 @end itemize
3723
3724 @node File Commands
3725 @subsection Commands Dealing with Files
3726 @cindex linker script file commands
3727 Several linker script commands deal with files.
3728
3729 @table @code
3730 @item INCLUDE @var{filename}
3731 @kindex INCLUDE @var{filename}
3732 @cindex including a linker script
3733 Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point. The file will
3734 be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified
3735 with the @option{-L} option. You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to
3736 10 levels deep.
3737
3738 You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or
3739 @code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions.
3740
3741 @item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3742 @itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3743 @kindex INPUT(@var{files})
3744 @cindex input files in linker scripts
3745 @cindex input object files in linker scripts
3746 @cindex linker script input object files
3747 The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files
3748 in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
3749
3750 For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do
3751 a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line,
3752 then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script.
3753
3754 In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker
3755 script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option.
3756
3757 In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts
3758 with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was
3759 located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked
3760 for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}. The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying
3761 @code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the
3762 filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of
3763 @samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
3764
3765 If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open
3766 the file in the directory containing the linker script. If it is not
3767 found the linker will then search the current directory. If it is still
3768 not found the linker will search through the archive library search
3769 path.
3770
3771 If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the
3772 name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument
3773 @samp{-l}.
3774
3775 When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the
3776 files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
3777 script file is included. This can affect archive searching.
3778
3779 @item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3780 @itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3781 @kindex GROUP(@var{files})
3782 @cindex grouping input files
3783 The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named
3784 files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
3785 new undefined references are created. See the description of @samp{-(}
3786 in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
3787
3788 @item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3789 @itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3790 @kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files})
3791 This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP}
3792 commands, among other filenames. The files listed will be handled
3793 as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands,
3794 with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
3795 when they are actually needed. This construct essentially enables
3796 @option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it
3797 and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed}
3798 setting afterwards.
3799
3800 @item OUTPUT(@var{filename})
3801 @kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename})
3802 @cindex output file name in linker script
3803 The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file. Using
3804 @code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using
3805 @samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command
3806 Line Options}). If both are used, the command-line option takes
3807 precedence.
3808
3809 You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the
3810 output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}.
3811
3812 @item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
3813 @kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
3814 @cindex library search path in linker script
3815 @cindex archive search path in linker script
3816 @cindex search path in linker script
3817 The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where
3818 @command{ld} looks for archive libraries. Using
3819 @code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}}
3820 on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both
3821 are used, then the linker will search both paths. Paths specified using
3822 the command-line option are searched first.
3823
3824 @item STARTUP(@var{filename})
3825 @kindex STARTUP(@var{filename})
3826 @cindex first input file
3827 The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except
3828 that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as
3829 though it were specified first on the command line. This may be useful
3830 when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the
3831 first file.
3832 @end table
3833
3834 @ifclear SingleFormat
3835 @node Format Commands
3836 @subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
3837 A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
3838
3839 @table @code
3840 @item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
3841 @itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little})
3842 @kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
3843 @cindex output file format in linker script
3844 The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the
3845 output file (@pxref{BFD}). Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is
3846 exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line
3847 (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both are used, the command
3848 line option takes precedence.
3849
3850 You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different
3851 formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options.
3852 This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
3853 desired endianness.
3854
3855 If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format
3856 will be the first argument, @var{default}. If @samp{-EB} is used, the
3857 output format will be the second argument, @var{big}. If @samp{-EL} is
3858 used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}.
3859
3860 For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this
3861 command:
3862 @smallexample
3863 OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
3864 @end smallexample
3865 This says that the default format for the output file is
3866 @samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line
3867 option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips}
3868 format.
3869
3870 @item TARGET(@var{bfdname})
3871 @kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname})
3872 @cindex input file format in linker script
3873 The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input
3874 files. It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands.
3875 This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line
3876 (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If the @code{TARGET} command
3877 is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET}
3878 command is also used to set the format for the output file. @xref{BFD}.
3879 @end table
3880 @end ifclear
3881
3882 @node REGION_ALIAS
3883 @subsection Assign alias names to memory regions
3884 @kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
3885 @cindex region alias
3886 @cindex region names
3887
3888 Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
3889 @ref{MEMORY} command. Each name corresponds to at most one memory region.
3890
3891 @smallexample
3892 REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
3893 @end smallexample
3894
3895 The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the
3896 memory region @var{region}. This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
3897 to memory regions. An example follows.
3898
3899 Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various
3900 memory storage devices. All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM}
3901 that allows code execution or data storage. Some may have a read-only,
3902 non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data
3903 access. The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with
3904 read-only data access and no code execution capability. We have four output
3905 sections:
3906
3907 @itemize @bullet
3908 @item
3909 @code{.text} program code;
3910 @item
3911 @code{.rodata} read-only data;
3912 @item
3913 @code{.data} read-write initialized data;
3914 @item
3915 @code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data.
3916 @end itemize
3917
3918 The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent
3919 part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the
3920 output sections to the memory regions available on the system. Our embedded
3921 systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and
3922 @code{C}:
3923 @multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25
3924 @item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C
3925 @item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM
3926 @item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2
3927 @item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2
3928 @item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM
3929 @end multitable
3930 The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is
3931 loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively. Please note that
3932 the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at
3933 the end of the @code{.rodata} section.
3934
3935 The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows. It
3936 includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the
3937 memory layout:
3938 @smallexample
3939 INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
3940
3941 SECTIONS
3942 @{
3943 .text :
3944 @{
3945 *(.text)
3946 @} > REGION_TEXT
3947 .rodata :
3948 @{
3949 *(.rodata)
3950 rodata_end = .;
3951 @} > REGION_RODATA
3952 .data : AT (rodata_end)
3953 @{
3954 data_start = .;
3955 *(.data)
3956 @} > REGION_DATA
3957 data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
3958 data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
3959 .bss :
3960 @{
3961 *(.bss)
3962 @} > REGION_BSS
3963 @}
3964 @end smallexample
3965
3966 Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory
3967 regions and alias names. The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three
3968 variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}:
3969 @table @code
3970 @item A
3971 Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}.
3972 @smallexample
3973 MEMORY
3974 @{
3975 RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
3976 @}
3977
3978 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
3979 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
3980 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
3981 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
3982 @end smallexample
3983 @item B
3984 Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}. Read-write data goes
3985 into the @code{RAM}. An image of the initialized data is loaded into the
3986 @code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}.
3987 @smallexample
3988 MEMORY
3989 @{
3990 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
3991 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
3992 @}
3993
3994 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
3995 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
3996 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
3997 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
3998 @end smallexample
3999 @item C
4000 Program code goes into the @code{ROM}. Read-only data goes into the
4001 @code{ROM2}. Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}. An image of the
4002 initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during
4003 system start into the @code{RAM}.
4004 @smallexample
4005 MEMORY
4006 @{
4007 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
4008 ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4009 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
4010 @}
4011
4012 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4013 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
4014 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4015 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4016 @end smallexample
4017 @end table
4018
4019 It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the
4020 @code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if
4021 necessary:
4022 @smallexample
4023 #include <string.h>
4024
4025 extern char data_start [];
4026 extern char data_size [];
4027 extern char data_load_start [];
4028
4029 void copy_data(void)
4030 @{
4031 if (data_start != data_load_start)
4032 @{
4033 memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
4034 @}
4035 @}
4036 @end smallexample
4037
4038 @node Miscellaneous Commands
4039 @subsection Other Linker Script Commands
4040 There are a few other linker scripts commands.
4041
4042 @table @code
4043 @item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message})
4044 @kindex ASSERT
4045 @cindex assertion in linker script
4046 Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero. If it is zero, then exit the linker
4047 with an error code, and print @var{message}.
4048
4049 Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking
4050 take place. This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd
4051 inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values
4052 for those symbols. The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd
4053 symbols that just reference dot. Thus an assertion like this:
4054
4055 @smallexample
4056 .stack :
4057 @{
4058 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4059 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4060 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4061 @}
4062 @end smallexample
4063
4064 will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere. Symbols
4065 PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they
4066 can be used inside ASSERTions. Thus:
4067
4068 @smallexample
4069 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4070 .stack :
4071 @{
4072 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4073 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4074 @}
4075 @end smallexample
4076
4077 will work.
4078
4079 @item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{})
4080 @kindex EXTERN
4081 @cindex undefined symbol in linker script
4082 Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
4083 symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
4084 modules from standard libraries. You may list several @var{symbol}s for
4085 each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times. This
4086 command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option.
4087
4088 @item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4089 @kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4090 @cindex common allocation in linker script
4091 This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option:
4092 to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
4093 output file is specified (@samp{-r}).
4094
4095 @item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4096 @kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4097 @cindex common allocation in linker script
4098 This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common}
4099 command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses
4100 to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
4101
4102 @item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4103 @kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4104 @cindex group allocation in linker script
4105 @cindex section groups
4106 @cindex COMDAT
4107 This command has the same effect as the
4108 @samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make
4109 @command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections,
4110 and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is
4111 specified (@samp{-r}).
4112
4113 @item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section}
4114 @kindex INSERT
4115 @cindex insert user script into default script
4116 This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to
4117 augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays. It
4118 inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
4119 @var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the
4120 default linker script. The exact insertion point is as for orphan
4121 sections. @xref{Location Counter}. The insertion happens after the
4122 linker has mapped input sections to output sections. Prior to the
4123 insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default
4124 linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the
4125 default linker script statements in the internal linker representation
4126 of the script. In particular, input section assignments will be made
4127 to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script. Here
4128 is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look:
4129
4130 @smallexample
4131 SECTIONS
4132 @{
4133 OVERLAY :
4134 @{
4135 .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @}
4136 .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @}
4137 @}
4138 @}
4139 INSERT AFTER .text;
4140 @end smallexample
4141
4142 @item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{})
4143 @kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections})
4144 @cindex cross references
4145 This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4146 references among certain output sections.
4147
4148 In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
4149 using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section
4150 will not be. Any direct references between the two sections would be
4151 errors. For example, it would be an error if code in one section called
4152 a function defined in the other section.
4153
4154 The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names. If
4155 @command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
4156 an error and returns a non-zero exit status. Note that the
4157 @code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section
4158 names.
4159
4160 @item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{})
4161 @kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections})
4162 @cindex cross references
4163 This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4164 references to one section from a list of other sections.
4165
4166 The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more
4167 output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where
4168 a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application
4169 there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety
4170 must never call back.
4171
4172 The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names.
4173 The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections.
4174 If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of
4175 the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit
4176 status. Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section
4177 names, not input section names.
4178
4179 @ifclear SingleFormat
4180 @item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4181 @kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4182 @cindex machine architecture
4183 @cindex architecture
4184 Specify a particular output machine architecture. The argument is one
4185 of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}). You can see the
4186 architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with
4187 the @samp{-f} option.
4188 @end ifclear
4189
4190 @item LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4191 @kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4192 This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior. If
4193 @var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers
4194 in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere.
4195 @xref{Expression Section}.
4196 @end table
4197
4198 @node Assignments
4199 @section Assigning Values to Symbols
4200 @cindex assignment in scripts
4201 @cindex symbol definition, scripts
4202 @cindex variables, defining
4203 You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script. This will define
4204 the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
4205
4206 @menu
4207 * Simple Assignments:: Simple Assignments
4208 * HIDDEN:: HIDDEN
4209 * PROVIDE:: PROVIDE
4210 * PROVIDE_HIDDEN:: PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4211 * Source Code Reference:: How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
4212 @end menu
4213
4214 @node Simple Assignments
4215 @subsection Simple Assignments
4216
4217 You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
4218
4219 @table @code
4220 @item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ;
4221 @itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ;
4222 @itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ;
4223 @itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ;
4224 @itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ;
4225 @itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ;
4226 @itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ;
4227 @itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ;
4228 @itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ;
4229 @end table
4230
4231 The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of
4232 @var{expression}. In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be
4233 defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly.
4234
4235 The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter. You
4236 may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command. @xref{Location Counter}.
4237
4238 The semicolon after @var{expression} is required.
4239
4240 Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}.
4241
4242 You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as
4243 statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output
4244 section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command.
4245
4246 The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
4247 expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}.
4248
4249 Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
4250 assignments may be used:
4251
4252 @smallexample
4253 floating_point = 0;
4254 SECTIONS
4255 @{
4256 .text :
4257 @{
4258 *(.text)
4259 _etext = .;
4260 @}
4261 _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
4262 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4263 @}
4264 @end smallexample
4265 @noindent
4266 In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as
4267 zero. The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following
4268 the last @samp{.text} input section. The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be
4269 defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned
4270 upward to a 4 byte boundary.
4271
4272 @node HIDDEN
4273 @subsection HIDDEN
4274 @cindex HIDDEN
4275 For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
4276 exported. The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4277
4278 Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use
4279 @code{HIDDEN}:
4280
4281 @smallexample
4282 HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
4283 SECTIONS
4284 @{
4285 .text :
4286 @{
4287 *(.text)
4288 HIDDEN(_etext = .);
4289 @}
4290 HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
4291 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4292 @}
4293 @end smallexample
4294 @noindent
4295 In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module.
4296
4297 @node PROVIDE
4298 @subsection PROVIDE
4299 @cindex PROVIDE
4300 In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
4301 only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
4302 the link. For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol
4303 @samp{etext}. However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use
4304 @samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error. The
4305 @code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as
4306 @samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined. The syntax is
4307 @code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4308
4309 Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}:
4310 @smallexample
4311 SECTIONS
4312 @{
4313 .text :
4314 @{
4315 *(.text)
4316 _etext = .;
4317 PROVIDE(etext = .);
4318 @}
4319 @}
4320 @end smallexample
4321
4322 In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading
4323 underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition error. If, on
4324 the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading
4325 underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
4326 If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the
4327 linker will use the definition in the linker script.
4328
4329 Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be
4330 defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol
4331 that the @code{PROVIDE} would create. This is particularly important
4332 when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as
4333 @samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols.
4334
4335 @node PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4336 @subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4337 @cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4338 Similar to @code{PROVIDE}. For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
4339 hidden and won't be exported.
4340
4341 @node Source Code Reference
4342 @subsection Source Code Reference
4343
4344 Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
4345 intuitive. In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to
4346 a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a
4347 symbol that does not have a value.
4348
4349 Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
4350 transform names in the source code into different names when they are
4351 stored in the symbol table. For example, Fortran compilers commonly
4352 prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name
4353 mangling}. Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name
4354 of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
4355 variable as it is defined in a linker script. For example in C a
4356 linker script variable might be referred to as:
4357
4358 @smallexample
4359 extern int foo;
4360 @end smallexample
4361
4362 But in the linker script it might be defined as:
4363
4364 @smallexample
4365 _foo = 1000;
4366 @end smallexample
4367
4368 In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
4369 transformation has taken place.
4370
4371 When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
4372 things happen. The first is that the compiler reserves enough space
4373 in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol. The
4374 second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol
4375 table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}. ie the symbol table
4376 contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's
4377 value. So for example the following C declaration, at file scope:
4378
4379 @smallexample
4380 int foo = 1000;
4381 @end smallexample
4382
4383 creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table. This entry
4384 holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the
4385 number 1000 is initially stored.
4386
4387 When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
4388 first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
4389 memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
4390 So:
4391
4392 @smallexample
4393 foo = 1;
4394 @end smallexample
4395
4396 looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address
4397 associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
4398 address. Whereas:
4399
4400 @smallexample
4401 int * a = & foo;
4402 @end smallexample
4403
4404 looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address
4405 and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with
4406 the variable @samp{a}.
4407
4408 Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
4409 the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them. Thus they are
4410 an address without a value. So for example the linker script definition:
4411
4412 @smallexample
4413 foo = 1000;
4414 @end smallexample
4415
4416 creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds
4417 the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
4418 address 1000. This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a
4419 linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
4420 access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol.
4421
4422 Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code
4423 you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to
4424 use its value. For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a
4425 section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the
4426 linker script contains these declarations:
4427
4428 @smallexample
4429 @group
4430 start_of_ROM = .ROM;
4431 end_of_ROM = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM);
4432 start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
4433 @end group
4434 @end smallexample
4435
4436 Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
4437
4438 @smallexample
4439 @group
4440 extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
4441
4442 memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
4443 @end group
4444 @end smallexample
4445
4446 Note the use of the @samp{&} operators. These are correct.
4447 Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or
4448 arrays and then the code will again work as expected:
4449
4450 @smallexample
4451 @group
4452 extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[];
4453
4454 memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM);
4455 @end group
4456 @end smallexample
4457
4458 Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&}
4459 operators.
4460
4461 @node SECTIONS
4462 @section SECTIONS Command
4463 @kindex SECTIONS
4464 The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections
4465 into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
4466
4467 The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is:
4468 @smallexample
4469 SECTIONS
4470 @{
4471 @var{sections-command}
4472 @var{sections-command}
4473 @dots{}
4474 @}
4475 @end smallexample
4476
4477 Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following:
4478
4479 @itemize @bullet
4480 @item
4481 an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command})
4482 @item
4483 a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4484 @item
4485 an output section description
4486 @item
4487 an overlay description
4488 @end itemize
4489
4490 The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
4491 @code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in
4492 those commands. This can also make the linker script easier to
4493 understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
4494 the layout of the output file.
4495
4496 Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
4497 below.
4498
4499 If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the
4500 linker will place each input section into an identically named output
4501 section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
4502 input files. If all input sections are present in the first file, for
4503 example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
4504 in the first input file. The first section will be at address zero.
4505
4506 @menu
4507 * Output Section Description:: Output section description
4508 * Output Section Name:: Output section name
4509 * Output Section Address:: Output section address
4510 * Input Section:: Input section description
4511 * Output Section Data:: Output section data
4512 * Output Section Keywords:: Output section keywords
4513 * Output Section Discarding:: Output section discarding
4514 * Output Section Attributes:: Output section attributes
4515 * Overlay Description:: Overlay description
4516 @end menu
4517
4518 @node Output Section Description
4519 @subsection Output Section Description
4520 The full description of an output section looks like this:
4521 @smallexample
4522 @group
4523 @var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
4524 [AT(@var{lma})]
4525 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
4526 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
4527 [@var{constraint}]
4528 @{
4529 @var{output-section-command}
4530 @var{output-section-command}
4531 @dots{}
4532 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,]
4533 @end group
4534 @end smallexample
4535
4536 Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes.
4537
4538 The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section
4539 name is unambiguous. The colon and the curly braces are also required.
4540 The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and
4541 the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
4542 The line breaks and other white space are optional.
4543
4544 Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following:
4545
4546 @itemize @bullet
4547 @item
4548 a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4549 @item
4550 an input section description (@pxref{Input Section})
4551 @item
4552 data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data})
4553 @item
4554 a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords})
4555 @end itemize
4556
4557 @node Output Section Name
4558 @subsection Output Section Name
4559 @cindex name, section
4560 @cindex section name
4561 The name of the output section is @var{section}. @var{section} must
4562 meet the constraints of your output format. In formats which only
4563 support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name
4564 must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for
4565 example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the
4566 output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not
4567 names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a
4568 quoted numeric string. A section name may consist of any sequence of
4569 characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as
4570 commas must be quoted.
4571
4572 The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section
4573 Discarding}.
4574
4575 @node Output Section Address
4576 @subsection Output Section Address
4577 @cindex address, section
4578 @cindex section address
4579 The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory
4580 address) of the output section. This address is optional, but if it
4581 is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
4582
4583 If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the
4584 section, based on the heuristic below. This address will be adjusted
4585 to fit the alignment requirement of the output section. The
4586 alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
4587 contained within the output section.
4588
4589 The output section address heuristic is as follows:
4590
4591 @itemize @bullet
4592 @item
4593 If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it
4594 is added to this region and its address will be the next free address
4595 in that region.
4596
4597 @item
4598 If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
4599 regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the
4600 section is selected to contain it. The section's output address will
4601 be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}.
4602
4603 @item
4604 If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
4605 the output address will be based on the current value of the location
4606 counter.
4607 @end itemize
4608
4609 @noindent
4610 For example:
4611
4612 @smallexample
4613 .text . : @{ *(.text) @}
4614 @end smallexample
4615
4616 @noindent
4617 and
4618
4619 @smallexample
4620 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
4621 @end smallexample
4622
4623 @noindent
4624 are subtly different. The first will set the address of the
4625 @samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location
4626 counter. The second will set it to the current value of the location
4627 counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text}
4628 input sections.
4629
4630 The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}.
4631 For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
4632 so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
4633 do something like this:
4634 @smallexample
4635 .text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @}
4636 @end smallexample
4637 @noindent
4638 This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter
4639 aligned upward to the specified value.
4640
4641 Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the
4642 location counter, provided that the section is non-empty. (Empty
4643 sections are ignored).
4644
4645 @node Input Section
4646 @subsection Input Section Description
4647 @cindex input sections
4648 @cindex mapping input sections to output sections
4649 The most common output section command is an input section description.
4650
4651 The input section description is the most basic linker script operation.
4652 You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program
4653 in memory. You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to
4654 map the input files into your memory layout.
4655
4656 @menu
4657 * Input Section Basics:: Input section basics
4658 * Input Section Wildcards:: Input section wildcard patterns
4659 * Input Section Common:: Input section for common symbols
4660 * Input Section Keep:: Input section and garbage collection
4661 * Input Section Example:: Input section example
4662 @end menu
4663
4664 @node Input Section Basics
4665 @subsubsection Input Section Basics
4666 @cindex input section basics
4667 An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
4668 by a list of section names in parentheses.
4669
4670 The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
4671 describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}).
4672
4673 The most common input section description is to include all input
4674 sections with a particular name in the output section. For example, to
4675 include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write:
4676 @smallexample
4677 *(.text)
4678 @end smallexample
4679 @noindent
4680 Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name. To exclude a list
4681 @cindex EXCLUDE_FILE
4682 of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to
4683 match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list. For
4684 example:
4685 @smallexample
4686 EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors)
4687 @end smallexample
4688 @noindent
4689 will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o}
4690 and @file{otherfile.o} to be included. The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be
4691 placed inside the section list, for example:
4692 @smallexample
4693 *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
4694 @end smallexample
4695 @noindent
4696 The result of this is identically to the previous example. Supporting
4697 two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains
4698 more than one section, as described below.
4699
4700 There are two ways to include more than one section:
4701 @smallexample
4702 *(.text .rdata)
4703 *(.text) *(.rdata)
4704 @end smallexample
4705 @noindent
4706 The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and
4707 @samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section. In the
4708 first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
4709 they are found in the linker input. In the second example, all
4710 @samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all
4711 @samp{.rdata} input sections.
4712
4713 When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion
4714 is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the
4715 immediately following section, for example:
4716 @smallexample
4717 *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata)
4718 @end smallexample
4719 @noindent
4720 will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except
4721 @file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections
4722 from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included. To
4723 exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example
4724 could be modified to:
4725 @smallexample
4726 *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata)
4727 @end smallexample
4728 @noindent
4729 Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list,
4730 before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for
4731 all sections. Thus the previous example can be rewritten as:
4732 @smallexample
4733 EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata)
4734 @end smallexample
4735
4736 You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file.
4737 You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that
4738 needs to be at a particular location in memory. For example:
4739 @smallexample
4740 data.o(.data)
4741 @end smallexample
4742
4743 To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
4744 of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
4745
4746 Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections:
4747
4748 @smallexample
4749 @group
4750 SECTIONS @{
4751 .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @}
4752 .text2 : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @}
4753 @}
4754 @end group
4755 @end smallexample
4756
4757 In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any
4758 input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
4759 @code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set. The output section
4760 @samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text)
4761 whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear.
4762
4763 You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
4764 matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file,
4765 with no whitespace around the colon.
4766
4767 @table @samp
4768 @item archive:file
4769 matches file within archive
4770 @item archive:
4771 matches the whole archive
4772 @item :file
4773 matches file but not one in an archive
4774 @end table
4775
4776 Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell
4777 wildcards. On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
4778 single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so
4779 @samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o}
4780 within an archive called @samp{c}. @samp{archive:file} filespecs may
4781 also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in
4782 other linker script contexts. For instance, you cannot extract a file
4783 from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT}
4784 command.
4785
4786 If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in
4787 the input file will be included in the output section. This is not
4788 commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion. For example:
4789 @smallexample
4790 data.o
4791 @end smallexample
4792
4793 When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier
4794 and does not contain any wild card
4795 characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file
4796 name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. If you
4797 did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as
4798 though it appeared on the command line. Note that this differs from an
4799 @code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in
4800 the archive search path.
4801
4802 @node Input Section Wildcards
4803 @subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns
4804 @cindex input section wildcards
4805 @cindex wildcard file name patterns
4806 @cindex file name wildcard patterns
4807 @cindex section name wildcard patterns
4808 In an input section description, either the file name or the section
4809 name or both may be wildcard patterns.
4810
4811 The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
4812 pattern for the file name.
4813
4814 The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
4815
4816 @table @samp
4817 @item *
4818 matches any number of characters
4819 @item ?
4820 matches any single character
4821 @item [@var{chars}]
4822 matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-}
4823 character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in
4824 @samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter
4825 @item \
4826 quotes the following character
4827 @end table
4828
4829 When a file name is matched with a wildcard, the wildcard characters
4830 will not match a @samp{/} character (used to separate directory names on
4831 Unix). A pattern consisting of a single @samp{*} character is an
4832 exception; it will always match any file name, whether it contains a
4833 @samp{/} or not. In a section name, the wildcard characters will match
4834 a @samp{/} character.
4835
4836 File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
4837 specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. The linker
4838 does not search directories to expand wildcards.
4839
4840 If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name
4841 appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker
4842 will use the first match in the linker script. For example, this
4843 sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
4844 @file{data.o} rule will not be used:
4845 @smallexample
4846 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4847 .data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @}
4848 @end smallexample
4849
4850 @cindex SORT_BY_NAME
4851 Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards
4852 in the order in which they are seen during the link. You can change
4853 this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard
4854 pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}). When the
4855 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections
4856 into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file.
4857
4858 @cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT
4859 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4860 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of
4861 alignment before placing them in the output file. Placing larger
4862 alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding
4863 needed.
4864
4865 @cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY
4866 @code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4867 @code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending
4868 numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the
4869 section name before placing them in the output file. In
4870 @code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is
4871 the init_priority. In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN},
4872 @code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority.
4873
4874 @cindex SORT
4875 @code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4876
4877 When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there
4878 can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
4879
4880 @enumerate
4881 @item
4882 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
4883 It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two
4884 sections have the same name.
4885 @item
4886 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
4887 It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two
4888 sections have the same alignment.
4889 @item
4890 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is
4891 treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern).
4892 @item
4893 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern))
4894 is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern).
4895 @item
4896 All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
4897 @end enumerate
4898
4899 When both command-line section sorting option and linker script
4900 section sorting command are used, section sorting command always
4901 takes precedence over the command-line option.
4902
4903 If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
4904 command-line option will make the section sorting command to be
4905 treated as nested sorting command.
4906
4907 @enumerate
4908 @item
4909 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with
4910 @option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to
4911 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
4912 @item
4913 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with
4914 @option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to
4915 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
4916 @end enumerate
4917
4918 If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
4919 command-line option will be ignored.
4920
4921 @cindex SORT_NONE
4922 @code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line
4923 section sorting option.
4924
4925 If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the
4926 @samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file. The map file shows
4927 precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
4928
4929 This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
4930 files. This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text}
4931 sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}.
4932 The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning
4933 with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the
4934 linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}.
4935 @smallexample
4936 @group
4937 SECTIONS @{
4938 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
4939 .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @}
4940 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4941 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
4942 @}
4943 @end group
4944 @end smallexample
4945
4946 @node Input Section Common
4947 @subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols
4948 @cindex common symbol placement
4949 @cindex uninitialized data placement
4950 A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
4951 file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section. The
4952 linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
4953 named @samp{COMMON}.
4954
4955 You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any
4956 other input sections. You can use this to place common symbols from a
4957 particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
4958 input files are placed in another section.
4959
4960 In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
4961 @samp{.bss} section in the output file. For example:
4962 @smallexample
4963 .bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @}
4964 @end smallexample
4965
4966 @cindex scommon section
4967 @cindex small common symbols
4968 Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol. For
4969 example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common
4970 symbols and small common symbols. In this case, the linker will use a
4971 different special section name for other types of common symbols. In
4972 the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common
4973 symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols. This permits you
4974 to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
4975 locations.
4976
4977 @cindex [COMMON]
4978 You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts. This
4979 notation is now considered obsolete. It is equivalent to
4980 @samp{*(COMMON)}.
4981
4982 @node Input Section Keep
4983 @subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection
4984 @cindex KEEP
4985 @cindex garbage collection
4986 When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}),
4987 it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.
4988 This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry
4989 with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or
4990 @code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}.
4991
4992 @node Input Section Example
4993 @subsubsection Input Section Example
4994 The following example is a complete linker script. It tells the linker
4995 to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the
4996 start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location
4997 @samp{0x10000}. All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o}
4998 follows immediately, in the same output section. All of section
4999 @samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section
5000 @samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}.
5001 All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any
5002 files are written to output section @samp{outputc}.
5003
5004 @smallexample
5005 @group
5006 SECTIONS @{
5007 outputa 0x10000 :
5008 @{
5009 all.o
5010 foo.o (.input1)
5011 @}
5012 @end group
5013 @group
5014 outputb :
5015 @{
5016 foo.o (.input2)
5017 foo1.o (.input1)
5018 @}
5019 @end group
5020 @group
5021 outputc :
5022 @{
5023 *(.input1)
5024 *(.input2)
5025 @}
5026 @}
5027 @end group
5028 @end smallexample
5029
5030 If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name
5031 and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will
5032 automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and
5033 __stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section. These
5034 indicate the start address and end address of the output section
5035 respectively. Note: most section names are not representable as
5036 C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character.
5037
5038 @node Output Section Data
5039 @subsection Output Section Data
5040 @cindex data
5041 @cindex section data
5042 @cindex output section data
5043 @kindex BYTE(@var{expression})
5044 @kindex SHORT(@var{expression})
5045 @kindex LONG(@var{expression})
5046 @kindex QUAD(@var{expression})
5047 @kindex SQUAD(@var{expression})
5048 You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
5049 @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as
5050 an output section command. Each keyword is followed by an expression in
5051 parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}). The
5052 value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location
5053 counter.
5054
5055 The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands
5056 store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively). After storing the
5057 bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes
5058 stored.
5059
5060 For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value
5061 of the symbol @samp{addr}:
5062 @smallexample
5063 BYTE(1)
5064 LONG(addr)
5065 @end smallexample
5066
5067 When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the
5068 same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value. When both host and
5069 target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits. In this case
5070 @code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and
5071 @code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
5072
5073 If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness,
5074 which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness.
5075 When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is
5076 true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the
5077 endianness of the first input object file.
5078
5079 Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not
5080 between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
5081 @smallexample
5082 SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5083 @end smallexample
5084 whereas this will work:
5085 @smallexample
5086 SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5087 @end smallexample
5088
5089 @kindex FILL(@var{expression})
5090 @cindex holes, filling
5091 @cindex unspecified memory
5092 You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the
5093 current section. It is followed by an expression in parentheses. Any
5094 otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
5095 gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
5096 with the value of the expression, repeated as
5097 necessary. A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the
5098 point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more
5099 than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in
5100 different parts of an output section.
5101
5102 This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
5103 value @samp{0x90}:
5104 @smallexample
5105 FILL(0x90909090)
5106 @end smallexample
5107
5108 The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output
5109 section attribute, but it only affects the
5110 part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the
5111 entire section. If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes
5112 precedence. @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill
5113 expression.
5114
5115 @node Output Section Keywords
5116 @subsection Output Section Keywords
5117 There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
5118 commands.
5119
5120 @table @code
5121 @kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5122 @cindex input filename symbols
5123 @cindex filename symbols
5124 @item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5125 The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file.
5126 The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input
5127 file. The section of each symbol will be the output section in which
5128 the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears.
5129
5130 This is conventional for the a.out object file format. It is not
5131 normally used for any other object file format.
5132
5133 @kindex CONSTRUCTORS
5134 @cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link
5135 @cindex constructors, arranging in link
5136 @item CONSTRUCTORS
5137 When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
5138 unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
5139 destructors. When linking object file formats which do not support
5140 arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
5141 automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name.
5142 For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the
5143 linker to place constructor information in the output section where the
5144 @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears. The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is
5145 ignored for other object file formats.
5146
5147 The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global
5148 constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end.
5149 Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark
5150 the start and end of the global destructors. The
5151 first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address
5152 of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word. The
5153 compiler must arrange to actually run the code. For these object file
5154 formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine
5155 @code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into
5156 the startup code for @code{main}. @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs
5157 destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function
5158 @code{exit}.
5159
5160 For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support
5161 arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the
5162 addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors}
5163 and @code{.dtors} sections. Placing the following sequence into your
5164 linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++
5165 runtime code expects to see.
5166
5167 @smallexample
5168 __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
5169 LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5170 *(.ctors)
5171 LONG(0)
5172 __CTOR_END__ = .;
5173 __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
5174 LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5175 *(.dtors)
5176 LONG(0)
5177 __DTOR_END__ = .;
5178 @end smallexample
5179
5180 If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority,
5181 which provides some control over the order in which global constructors
5182 are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they
5183 are executed in the correct order. When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS}
5184 command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead. When using the
5185 @code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and
5186 @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and
5187 @samp{*(.dtors)}.
5188
5189 Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically,
5190 and you will not need to concern yourself with them. However, you may
5191 need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker
5192 scripts.
5193
5194 @end table
5195
5196 @node Output Section Discarding
5197 @subsection Output Section Discarding
5198 @cindex discarding sections
5199 @cindex sections, discarding
5200 @cindex removing sections
5201 The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
5202 This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
5203 may not be present in any of the input files. For example:
5204 @smallexample
5205 .foo : @{ *(.foo) @}
5206 @end smallexample
5207 @noindent
5208 will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a
5209 @samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input
5210 sections are not all empty. Other link script directives that allocate
5211 space in an output section will also create the output section. So
5212 too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create
5213 space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym},
5214 @samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when
5215 @samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script.
5216 This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}.
5217
5218 The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address})
5219 on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines
5220 symbols in the output section. In that case the linker will obey
5221 the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
5222 section is discarded.
5223
5224 @cindex /DISCARD/
5225 The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard
5226 input sections. Any input sections which are assigned to an output
5227 section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file.
5228
5229 Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be
5230 discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other
5231 members which are not being discarded. This is deliberate.
5232 Discarding takes precedence over grouping.
5233
5234 @node Output Section Attributes
5235 @subsection Output Section Attributes
5236 @cindex output section attributes
5237 We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
5238 like this:
5239
5240 @smallexample
5241 @group
5242 @var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
5243 [AT(@var{lma})]
5244 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
5245 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
5246 [@var{constraint}]
5247 @{
5248 @var{output-section-command}
5249 @var{output-section-command}
5250 @dots{}
5251 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}]
5252 @end group
5253 @end smallexample
5254
5255 We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and
5256 @var{output-section-command}. In this section we will describe the
5257 remaining section attributes.
5258
5259 @menu
5260 * Output Section Type:: Output section type
5261 * Output Section LMA:: Output section LMA
5262 * Forced Output Alignment:: Forced Output Alignment
5263 * Forced Input Alignment:: Forced Input Alignment
5264 * Output Section Constraint:: Output section constraint
5265 * Output Section Region:: Output section region
5266 * Output Section Phdr:: Output section phdr
5267 * Output Section Fill:: Output section fill
5268 @end menu
5269
5270 @node Output Section Type
5271 @subsubsection Output Section Type
5272 Each output section may have a type. The type is a keyword in
5273 parentheses. The following types are defined:
5274
5275 @table @code
5276 @item NOLOAD
5277 The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be
5278 loaded into memory when the program is run.
5279 @item DSECT
5280 @itemx COPY
5281 @itemx INFO
5282 @itemx OVERLAY
5283 These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
5284 rarely used. They all have the same effect: the section should be
5285 marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
5286 section when the program is run.
5287 @end table
5288
5289 @kindex NOLOAD
5290 @cindex prevent unnecessary loading
5291 @cindex loading, preventing
5292 The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
5293 the input sections which map into it. You can override this by using
5294 the section type. For example, in the script sample below, the
5295 @samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not
5296 need to be loaded when the program is run.
5297 @smallexample
5298 @group
5299 SECTIONS @{
5300 ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @}
5301 @dots{}
5302 @}
5303 @end group
5304 @end smallexample
5305
5306 @node Output Section LMA
5307 @subsubsection Output Section LMA
5308 @kindex AT>@var{lma_region}
5309 @kindex AT(@var{lma})
5310 @cindex load address
5311 @cindex section load address
5312 Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
5313 @ref{Basic Script Concepts}. The virtual address is specified by the
5314 @pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier. The load address is
5315 specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords. Specifying a load
5316 address is optional.
5317
5318 The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument. This
5319 specifies the exact load address of the section. The @code{AT>} keyword
5320 takes the name of a memory region as an argument. @xref{MEMORY}. The
5321 load address of the section is set to the next free address in the
5322 region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
5323
5324 If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable
5325 section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the
5326 load address:
5327
5328 @itemize @bullet
5329 @item
5330 If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
5331 the LMA address as well.
5332
5333 @item
5334 If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
5335
5336 @item
5337 Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible
5338 with the current section, and this region contains at least one
5339 section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the
5340 VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of
5341 the last section in the located region.
5342
5343 @item
5344 If no memory regions have been declared then a default region
5345 that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
5346
5347 @item
5348 If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
5349 section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
5350 @end itemize
5351
5352 @cindex ROM initialized data
5353 @cindex initialized data in ROM
5354 This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image. For
5355 example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
5356 called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called
5357 @samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section
5358 even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold
5359 uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}. The symbol @code{_data} is
5360 defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location
5361 counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
5362
5363 @smallexample
5364 @group
5365 SECTIONS
5366 @{
5367 .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @}
5368 .mdata 0x2000 :
5369 AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
5370 @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ; @}
5371 .bss 0x3000 :
5372 @{ _bstart = . ; *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@}
5373 @}
5374 @end group
5375 @end smallexample
5376
5377 The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with
5378 this linker script would include something like the following, to copy
5379 the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address. Notice
5380 how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker
5381 script.
5382
5383 @smallexample
5384 @group
5385 extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
5386 char *src = &_etext;
5387 char *dst = &_data;
5388
5389 /* ROM has data at end of text; copy it. */
5390 while (dst < &_edata)
5391 *dst++ = *src++;
5392
5393 /* Zero bss. */
5394 for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
5395 *dst = 0;
5396 @end group
5397 @end smallexample
5398
5399 @node Forced Output Alignment
5400 @subsubsection Forced Output Alignment
5401 @kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align})
5402 @cindex forcing output section alignment
5403 @cindex output section alignment
5404 You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN. As an
5405 alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains
5406 intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute.
5407
5408 @node Forced Input Alignment
5409 @subsubsection Forced Input Alignment
5410 @kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})
5411 @cindex forcing input section alignment
5412 @cindex input section alignment
5413 You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
5414 SUBALIGN. The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
5415 sections, whether larger or smaller.
5416
5417 @node Output Section Constraint
5418 @subsubsection Output Section Constraint
5419 @kindex ONLY_IF_RO
5420 @kindex ONLY_IF_RW
5421 @cindex constraints on output sections
5422 You can specify that an output section should only be created if all
5423 of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
5424 read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and
5425 @code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively.
5426
5427 @node Output Section Region
5428 @subsubsection Output Section Region
5429 @kindex >@var{region}
5430 @cindex section, assigning to memory region
5431 @cindex memory regions and sections
5432 You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
5433 using @samp{>@var{region}}. @xref{MEMORY}.
5434
5435 Here is a simple example:
5436 @smallexample
5437 @group
5438 MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @}
5439 SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @}
5440 @end group
5441 @end smallexample
5442
5443 @node Output Section Phdr
5444 @subsubsection Output Section Phdr
5445 @kindex :@var{phdr}
5446 @cindex section, assigning to program header
5447 @cindex program headers and sections
5448 You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
5449 using @samp{:@var{phdr}}. @xref{PHDRS}. If a section is assigned to
5450 one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be
5451 assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly
5452 @code{:@var{phdr}} modifier. You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the
5453 linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
5454
5455 Here is a simple example:
5456 @smallexample
5457 @group
5458 PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @}
5459 SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @}
5460 @end group
5461 @end smallexample
5462
5463 @node Output Section Fill
5464 @subsubsection Output Section Fill
5465 @kindex =@var{fillexp}
5466 @cindex section fill pattern
5467 @cindex fill pattern, entire section
5468 You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using
5469 @samp{=@var{fillexp}}. @var{fillexp} is an expression
5470 (@pxref{Expressions}). Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory
5471 within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required
5472 alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as
5473 necessary. If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string
5474 of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then
5475 an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the
5476 fill pattern; Leading zeros become part of the pattern too. For all
5477 other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill
5478 pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the
5479 expression. In all cases, the number is big-endian.
5480
5481 You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the
5482 output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}).
5483
5484 Here is a simple example:
5485 @smallexample
5486 @group
5487 SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @}
5488 @end group
5489 @end smallexample
5490
5491 @node Overlay Description
5492 @subsection Overlay Description
5493 @kindex OVERLAY
5494 @cindex overlays
5495 An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
5496 are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
5497 the same memory address. At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
5498 copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
5499 required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits. This approach
5500 can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
5501 than another.
5502
5503 Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command. The
5504 @code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an
5505 output section description. The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY}
5506 command is as follows:
5507 @smallexample
5508 @group
5509 OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )]
5510 @{
5511 @var{secname1}
5512 @{
5513 @var{output-section-command}
5514 @var{output-section-command}
5515 @dots{}
5516 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5517 @var{secname2}
5518 @{
5519 @var{output-section-command}
5520 @var{output-section-command}
5521 @dots{}
5522 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5523 @dots{}
5524 @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,]
5525 @end group
5526 @end smallexample
5527
5528 Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each
5529 section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above). The
5530 section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to
5531 those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}),
5532 except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for
5533 sections within an @code{OVERLAY}.
5534
5535 The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and
5536 the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
5537
5538 The sections are all defined with the same starting address. The load
5539 addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in
5540 memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a
5541 whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional,
5542 and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional,
5543 and defaults to the current value of the location counter).
5544
5545 If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any
5546 references among the sections, the linker will report an error. Since
5547 the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make
5548 sense for one section to refer directly to another.
5549 @xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}.
5550
5551 For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically
5552 provides two symbols. The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is
5553 defined as the starting load address of the section. The symbol
5554 @code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of
5555 the section. Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal
5556 within C identifiers are removed. C (or assembler) code may use these
5557 symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
5558
5559 At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to
5560 the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section.
5561
5562 Here is an example. Remember that this would appear inside a
5563 @code{SECTIONS} construct.
5564 @smallexample
5565 @group
5566 OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
5567 @{
5568 .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5569 .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5570 @}
5571 @end group
5572 @end smallexample
5573 @noindent
5574 This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at
5575 address 0x1000. @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and
5576 @samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}. The
5577 following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0},
5578 @code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1},
5579 @code{__load_stop_text1}.
5580
5581 C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look
5582 like the following.
5583
5584 @smallexample
5585 @group
5586 extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
5587 memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
5588 &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
5589 @end group
5590 @end smallexample
5591
5592 Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since
5593 everything it does can be done using the more basic commands. The above
5594 example could have been written identically as follows.
5595
5596 @smallexample
5597 @group
5598 .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5599 PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
5600 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
5601 .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5602 PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
5603 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
5604 . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
5605 @end group
5606 @end smallexample
5607
5608 @node MEMORY
5609 @section MEMORY Command
5610 @kindex MEMORY
5611 @cindex memory regions
5612 @cindex regions of memory
5613 @cindex allocating memory
5614 @cindex discontinuous memory
5615 The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
5616 memory. You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command.
5617
5618 The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of
5619 memory in the target. You can use it to describe which memory regions
5620 may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid. You
5621 can then assign sections to particular memory regions. The linker will
5622 set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
5623 regions that become too full. The linker will not shuffle sections
5624 around to fit into the available regions.
5625
5626 A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command,
5627 however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were
5628 specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command. The syntax for
5629 @code{MEMORY} is:
5630 @smallexample
5631 @group
5632 MEMORY
5633 @{
5634 @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len}
5635 @dots{}
5636 @}
5637 @end group
5638 @end smallexample
5639
5640 The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the
5641 region. The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.
5642 Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5643 with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each memory region
5644 must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command. However you can
5645 add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS}
5646 command.
5647
5648 @cindex memory region attributes
5649 The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify
5650 whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
5651 not explicitly mapped in the linker script. As described in
5652 @ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input
5653 section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
5654 the input section. If you define region attributes, the linker will use
5655 them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
5656
5657 The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters:
5658 @table @samp
5659 @item R
5660 Read-only section
5661 @item W
5662 Read/write section
5663 @item X
5664 Executable section
5665 @item A
5666 Allocatable section
5667 @item I
5668 Initialized section
5669 @item L
5670 Same as @samp{I}
5671 @item !
5672 Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
5673 @end table
5674
5675 If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
5676 @samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region. The @samp{!}
5677 attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an
5678 unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does
5679 not match any of the attributes listed afterwards. Thus an attribute
5680 string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either
5681 or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as
5682 the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute.
5683
5684 @kindex ORIGIN =
5685 @kindex o =
5686 @kindex org =
5687 The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of
5688 the memory region. The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
5689 cannot involve any symbols. The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be
5690 abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example,
5691 @code{ORG}).
5692
5693 @kindex LENGTH =
5694 @kindex len =
5695 @kindex l =
5696 The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory
5697 region. As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must
5698 be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant. The keyword
5699 @code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}.
5700
5701 In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions
5702 available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes,
5703 and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes. The
5704 linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which
5705 is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only
5706 or executable. The linker will place other sections which are not
5707 explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory
5708 region.
5709
5710 @smallexample
5711 @group
5712 MEMORY
5713 @{
5714 rom (rx) : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
5715 ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
5716 @}
5717 @end group
5718 @end smallexample
5719
5720 Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
5721 specific output sections into that memory region by using the
5722 @samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute. For example, if you have
5723 a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the
5724 output section definition. @xref{Output Section Region}. If no address
5725 was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to
5726 the next available address within the memory region. If the combined
5727 output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the
5728 region, the linker will issue an error message.
5729
5730 It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
5731 expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and
5732 @code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions:
5733
5734 @smallexample
5735 @group
5736 _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
5737 @end group
5738 @end smallexample
5739
5740 @node PHDRS
5741 @section PHDRS Command
5742 @kindex PHDRS
5743 @cindex program headers
5744 @cindex ELF program headers
5745 @cindex program segments
5746 @cindex segments, ELF
5747 The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as
5748 @dfn{segments}. The program headers describe how the program should be
5749 loaded into memory. You can print them out by using the @code{objdump}
5750 program with the @samp{-p} option.
5751
5752 When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
5753 reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
5754 program. This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
5755 This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
5756 interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
5757
5758 The linker will create reasonable program headers by default. However,
5759 in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
5760 precisely. You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose. When
5761 the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will
5762 not create any program headers other than the ones specified.
5763
5764 The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when
5765 generating an ELF output file. In other cases, the linker will simply
5766 ignore @code{PHDRS}.
5767
5768 This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command. The words @code{PHDRS},
5769 @code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords.
5770
5771 @smallexample
5772 @group
5773 PHDRS
5774 @{
5775 @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ]
5776 [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ;
5777 @}
5778 @end group
5779 @end smallexample
5780
5781 The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command
5782 of the linker script. It is not put into the output file. Program
5783 header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5784 with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each program header
5785 must have a distinct name. The headers are processed in order and it
5786 is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
5787
5788 Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
5789 system loader will load from the file. In the linker script, you
5790 specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
5791 sections in the segments. You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section
5792 attribute to place a section in a particular segment. @xref{Output
5793 Section Phdr}.
5794
5795 It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment. This
5796 merely implies that one segment of memory contains another. You may
5797 repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should
5798 contain the section.
5799
5800 If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}},
5801 then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do
5802 not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments. This is for
5803 convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be
5804 placed in a single segment. You can use @code{:NONE} to override the
5805 default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any
5806 segment at all.
5807
5808 @kindex FILEHDR
5809 @kindex PHDRS
5810 You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after
5811 the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment.
5812 The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF
5813 file header. The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should
5814 include the ELF program headers themselves. If applied to a loadable
5815 segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of
5816 these keywords.
5817
5818 The @var{type} may be one of the following. The numbers indicate the
5819 value of the keyword.
5820
5821 @table @asis
5822 @item @code{PT_NULL} (0)
5823 Indicates an unused program header.
5824
5825 @item @code{PT_LOAD} (1)
5826 Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from
5827 the file.
5828
5829 @item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2)
5830 Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
5831
5832 @item @code{PT_INTERP} (3)
5833 Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be
5834 found.
5835
5836 @item @code{PT_NOTE} (4)
5837 Indicates a segment holding note information.
5838
5839 @item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5)
5840 A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF
5841 ABI.
5842
5843 @item @code{PT_PHDR} (6)
5844 Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
5845
5846 @item @code{PT_TLS} (7)
5847 Indicates a segment containing thread local storage.
5848
5849 @item @var{expression}
5850 An expression giving the numeric type of the program header. This may
5851 be used for types not defined above.
5852 @end table
5853
5854 You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address
5855 in memory by using an @code{AT} expression. This is identical to the
5856 @code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output
5857 Section LMA}). The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the
5858 output section attribute.
5859
5860 The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
5861 which comprise the segment. You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to
5862 explicitly specify the segment flags. The value of @var{flags} must be
5863 an integer. It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program
5864 header.
5865
5866 Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}. This shows a typical set of program
5867 headers used on a native ELF system.
5868
5869 @example
5870 @group
5871 PHDRS
5872 @{
5873 headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
5874 interp PT_INTERP ;
5875 text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
5876 data PT_LOAD ;
5877 dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
5878 @}
5879
5880 SECTIONS
5881 @{
5882 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
5883 .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp
5884 .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text
5885 .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */
5886 @dots{}
5887 . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
5888 .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data
5889 .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic
5890 @dots{}
5891 @}
5892 @end group
5893 @end example
5894
5895 @node VERSION
5896 @section VERSION Command
5897 @kindex VERSION @{script text@}
5898 @cindex symbol versions
5899 @cindex version script
5900 @cindex versions of symbols
5901 The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF. Symbol versions are
5902 only useful when using shared libraries. The dynamic linker can use
5903 symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
5904 a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
5905 shared library.
5906
5907 You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or
5908 you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script. You can
5909 also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option.
5910
5911 The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply
5912 @smallexample
5913 VERSION @{ version-script-commands @}
5914 @end smallexample
5915
5916 The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by
5917 Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5. The version script defines a tree of
5918 version nodes. You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
5919 version script. You can specify which symbols are bound to which
5920 version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
5921 scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
5922 library.
5923
5924 The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few
5925 examples.
5926
5927 @smallexample
5928 VERS_1.1 @{
5929 global:
5930 foo1;
5931 local:
5932 old*;
5933 original*;
5934 new*;
5935 @};
5936
5937 VERS_1.2 @{
5938 foo2;
5939 @} VERS_1.1;
5940
5941 VERS_2.0 @{
5942 bar1; bar2;
5943 extern "C++" @{
5944 ns::*;
5945 "f(int, double)";
5946 @};
5947 @} VERS_1.2;
5948 @end smallexample
5949
5950 This example version script defines three version nodes. The first
5951 version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies.
5952 The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}. It reduces
5953 a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside
5954 of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
5955 symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new}
5956 is matched. The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used
5957 in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing'').
5958 However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the
5959 name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
5960
5961 Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}. This node
5962 depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}. The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2}
5963 to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}.
5964
5965 Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}. This node
5966 depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}. The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1}
5967 and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}.
5968
5969 When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
5970 specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
5971 unspecified base version of the library. You can bind all otherwise
5972 unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;}
5973 somewhere in the version script. Note that it's slightly crazy to use
5974 wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node. Global
5975 wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
5976 set exported for an old version. That's wrong since older versions
5977 ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
5978
5979 The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what
5980 they might suggest to the person reading them. The @samp{2.0} version
5981 could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}.
5982 However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
5983
5984 Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node
5985 in the version script. Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
5986 symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which
5987 won't.
5988
5989 @smallexample
5990 @{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @};
5991 @end smallexample
5992
5993 When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned
5994 symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it
5995 requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each
5996 shared library it is linked against. Thus at runtime, the dynamic
5997 loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
5998 linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
5999 application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols. In this
6000 way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
6001 all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
6002 search for each symbol reference.
6003
6004 The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
6005 doing minor version checking that SunOS does. The fundamental problem
6006 that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
6007 functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
6008 the application starts up. If a shared library is out of date, a
6009 required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
6010 that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail. With symbol
6011 versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
6012 the libraries being used with the application are too old.
6013
6014 There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach. The
6015 first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
6016 source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
6017 script. This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
6018 maintainer. You can do this by putting something like:
6019 @smallexample
6020 __asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6021 @end smallexample
6022 @noindent
6023 in the C source file. This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to
6024 be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}.
6025 The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol
6026 @samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive
6027 takes precedence over a version script.
6028
6029 The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
6030 function to appear in a given shared library. In this way you can make
6031 an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
6032 version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
6033 linked against the old interface to continue to function.
6034
6035 To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the
6036 source file. Here is an example:
6037
6038 @smallexample
6039 __asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@");
6040 __asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6041 __asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2");
6042 __asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0");
6043 @end smallexample
6044
6045 In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the
6046 unspecified base version of the symbol. The source file that contains this
6047 example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo},
6048 @samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}.
6049
6050 When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be
6051 some way to specify a default version to which external references to
6052 this symbol will be bound. You can do this with the
6053 @samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive. You can only
6054 declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise
6055 you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
6056
6057 If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
6058 within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
6059 (i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to
6060 specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
6061
6062 You can also specify the language in the version script:
6063
6064 @smallexample
6065 VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @}
6066 @end smallexample
6067
6068 The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}.
6069 The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and
6070 demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the
6071 patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}. The default
6072 @samp{lang} is @samp{C}.
6073
6074 Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters. As
6075 described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
6076 or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly. In
6077 the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
6078 whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
6079 cause a mismatch. As the exact string generated by the demangler
6080 might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you
6081 should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you
6082 expect when you upgrade.
6083
6084 @node Expressions
6085 @section Expressions in Linker Scripts
6086 @cindex expressions
6087 @cindex arithmetic
6088 The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
6089 that of C expressions. All expressions are evaluated as integers. All
6090 expressions are evaluated in the same size, which is 32 bits if both the
6091 host and target are 32 bits, and is otherwise 64 bits.
6092
6093 You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
6094
6095 The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in
6096 expressions.
6097
6098 @menu
6099 * Constants:: Constants
6100 * Symbolic Constants:: Symbolic constants
6101 * Symbols:: Symbol Names
6102 * Orphan Sections:: Orphan Sections
6103 * Location Counter:: The Location Counter
6104 * Operators:: Operators
6105 * Evaluation:: Evaluation
6106 * Expression Section:: The Section of an Expression
6107 * Builtin Functions:: Builtin Functions
6108 @end menu
6109
6110 @node Constants
6111 @subsection Constants
6112 @cindex integer notation
6113 @cindex constants in linker scripts
6114 All constants are integers.
6115
6116 As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be
6117 octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be
6118 hexadecimal. Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or
6119 @samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or
6120 @samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal. Any integer
6121 value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal.
6122
6123 @cindex scaled integers
6124 @cindex K and M integer suffixes
6125 @cindex M and K integer suffixes
6126 @cindex suffixes for integers
6127 @cindex integer suffixes
6128 In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a
6129 constant by
6130 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6131 @ifnottex
6132 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6133 @code{1024} or @code{1024*1024}
6134 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6135 @end ifnottex
6136 @tex
6137 ${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$
6138 @end tex
6139 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6140 respectively. For example, the following
6141 all refer to the same quantity:
6142
6143 @smallexample
6144 _fourk_1 = 4K;
6145 _fourk_2 = 4096;
6146 _fourk_3 = 0x1000;
6147 _fourk_4 = 10000o;
6148 @end smallexample
6149
6150 Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in
6151 conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above.
6152
6153 @node Symbolic Constants
6154 @subsection Symbolic Constants
6155 @cindex symbolic constants
6156 @kindex CONSTANT
6157 It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of
6158 the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of:
6159
6160 @table @code
6161 @item MAXPAGESIZE
6162 @kindex MAXPAGESIZE
6163 The target's maximum page size.
6164
6165 @item COMMONPAGESIZE
6166 @kindex COMMONPAGESIZE
6167 The target's default page size.
6168 @end table
6169
6170 So for example:
6171
6172 @smallexample
6173 .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @}
6174 @end smallexample
6175
6176 will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
6177 supported by the target.
6178
6179 @node Symbols
6180 @subsection Symbol Names
6181 @cindex symbol names
6182 @cindex names
6183 @cindex quoted symbol names
6184 @kindex "
6185 Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
6186 and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
6187 Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords. You can
6188 specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
6189 keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
6190 @smallexample
6191 "SECTION" = 9;
6192 "with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
6193 @end smallexample
6194
6195 Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest
6196 to delimit symbols with spaces. For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol,
6197 whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction.
6198
6199 @node Orphan Sections
6200 @subsection Orphan Sections
6201 @cindex orphan
6202 Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which
6203 are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker
6204 script. The linker will still copy these sections into the
6205 output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section
6206 in which to place the orphaned input section.
6207
6208 If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of
6209 an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be
6210 placed at the end of that output section.
6211
6212 If there is no output section with a matching name then new output
6213 sections will be created. Each new output section will have the same
6214 name as the orphan section placed within it. If there are multiple
6215 orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into
6216 one new output section.
6217
6218 If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections,
6219 then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections
6220 in relation to existing output sections. On most modern targets, the
6221 linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same
6222 attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc. If no
6223 sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this
6224 support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file.
6225
6226 The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique}
6227 (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which
6228 output sections an orphan is placed in.
6229
6230 @node Location Counter
6231 @subsection The Location Counter
6232 @kindex .
6233 @cindex dot
6234 @cindex location counter
6235 @cindex current output location
6236 The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the
6237 current output location counter. Since the @code{.} always refers to a
6238 location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression
6239 within a @code{SECTIONS} command. The @code{.} symbol may appear
6240 anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
6241
6242 @cindex holes
6243 Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be
6244 moved. This may be used to create holes in the output section. The
6245 location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
6246 and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so
6247 doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
6248
6249 @smallexample
6250 SECTIONS
6251 @{
6252 output :
6253 @{
6254 file1(.text)
6255 . = . + 1000;
6256 file2(.text)
6257 . += 1000;
6258 file3(.text)
6259 @} = 0x12345678;
6260 @}
6261 @end smallexample
6262 @noindent
6263 In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is
6264 located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}. It is
6265 followed by a 1000 byte gap. Then the @samp{.text} section from
6266 @file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the
6267 @samp{.text} section from @file{file3}. The notation @samp{= 0x12345678}
6268 specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}).
6269
6270 @cindex dot inside sections
6271 Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
6272 current containing object. Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS}
6273 statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an
6274 absolute address. If @code{.} is used inside a section description
6275 however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section,
6276 not an absolute address. Thus in a script like this:
6277
6278 @smallexample
6279 SECTIONS
6280 @{
6281 . = 0x100
6282 .text: @{
6283 *(.text)
6284 . = 0x200
6285 @}
6286 . = 0x500
6287 .data: @{
6288 *(.data)
6289 . += 0x600
6290 @}
6291 @}
6292 @end smallexample
6293
6294 The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100
6295 and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in
6296 the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area. (If there is too
6297 much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to
6298 move @code{.} backwards). The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500
6299 and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of
6300 the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of
6301 the @samp{.data} output section itself.
6302
6303 @cindex dot outside sections
6304 Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
6305 output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
6306 needs to place orphan sections. For example, given the following:
6307
6308 @smallexample
6309 SECTIONS
6310 @{
6311 start_of_text = . ;
6312 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6313 end_of_text = . ;
6314
6315 start_of_data = . ;
6316 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6317 end_of_data = . ;
6318 @}
6319 @end smallexample
6320
6321 If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata},
6322 not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section
6323 between @code{.text} and @code{.data}. You might think the linker
6324 should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but
6325 blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker. As well,
6326 the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their
6327 sections. Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other
6328 statements belong to the previous output section, except for the
6329 special case of an assignment to @code{.}. I.e., the linker will
6330 place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written
6331 as follows:
6332
6333 @smallexample
6334 SECTIONS
6335 @{
6336 start_of_text = . ;
6337 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6338 end_of_text = . ;
6339
6340 start_of_data = . ;
6341 .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @}
6342 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6343 end_of_data = . ;
6344 @}
6345 @end smallexample
6346
6347 This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
6348 @code{start_of_data}. One way to influence the orphan section
6349 placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker
6350 assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of
6351 a following output section and thus should be grouped with that
6352 section. So you could write:
6353
6354 @smallexample
6355 SECTIONS
6356 @{
6357 start_of_text = . ;
6358 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6359 end_of_text = . ;
6360
6361 . = . ;
6362 start_of_data = . ;
6363 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6364 end_of_data = . ;
6365 @}
6366 @end smallexample
6367
6368 Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between
6369 @code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}.
6370
6371 @need 2000
6372 @node Operators
6373 @subsection Operators
6374 @cindex operators for arithmetic
6375 @cindex arithmetic operators
6376 @cindex precedence in expressions
6377 The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
6378 the standard bindings and precedence levels:
6379 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6380 @ifnottex
6381 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6382 @smallexample
6383 precedence associativity Operators Notes
6384 (highest)
6385 1 left ! - ~ (1)
6386 2 left * / %
6387 3 left + -
6388 4 left >> <<
6389 5 left == != > < <= >=
6390 6 left &
6391 7 left |
6392 8 left &&
6393 9 left ||
6394 10 right ? :
6395 11 right &= += -= *= /= (2)
6396 (lowest)
6397 @end smallexample
6398 Notes:
6399 (1) Prefix operators
6400 (2) @xref{Assignments}.
6401 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6402 @end ifnottex
6403 @tex
6404 \vskip \baselineskip
6405 %"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample
6406 \hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip
6407 \hrule
6408 \halign
6409 {\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr
6410 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6411 &Precedence&& Associativity &&{\rm Operators}&\cr
6412 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6413 \noalign{\hrule}
6414 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6415 &highest&&&&&\cr
6416 % '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font
6417 &1&&left&&\qquad- \char'176\ !\qquad\dag&\cr
6418 &2&&left&&* / \%&\cr
6419 &3&&left&&+ -&\cr
6420 &4&&left&&>> <<&\cr
6421 &5&&left&&== != > < <= >=&\cr
6422 &6&&left&&\&&\cr
6423 &7&&left&&|&\cr
6424 &8&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr
6425 &9&&left&&||&\cr
6426 &10&&right&&? :&\cr
6427 &11&&right&&\qquad\&= += -= *= /=\qquad\ddag&\cr
6428 &lowest&&&&&\cr
6429 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr}
6430 \hrule}
6431 @end tex
6432 @iftex
6433 {
6434 @obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt
6435 @dag@quad Prefix operators.
6436 @ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}.
6437 }
6438 @end iftex
6439 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6440
6441 @node Evaluation
6442 @subsection Evaluation
6443 @cindex lazy evaluation
6444 @cindex expression evaluation order
6445 The linker evaluates expressions lazily. It only computes the value of
6446 an expression when absolutely necessary.
6447
6448 The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
6449 address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
6450 regions, in order to do any linking at all. These values are computed
6451 as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
6452
6453 However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
6454 until after storage allocation. Such values are evaluated later, when
6455 other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
6456 for use in the symbol assignment expression.
6457
6458 The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
6459 assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
6460 allocation.
6461
6462 Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
6463 @samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation.
6464
6465 If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
6466 available, then an error results. For example, a script like the
6467 following
6468 @smallexample
6469 @group
6470 SECTIONS
6471 @{
6472 .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
6473 @{ *(.text) @}
6474 @}
6475 @end group
6476 @end smallexample
6477 @noindent
6478 will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial
6479 address}.
6480
6481 @node Expression Section
6482 @subsection The Section of an Expression
6483 @cindex expression sections
6484 @cindex absolute expressions
6485 @cindex relative expressions
6486 @cindex absolute and relocatable symbols
6487 @cindex relocatable and absolute symbols
6488 @cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute
6489 Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute. A section
6490 relative symbol is relocatable. If you request relocatable output
6491 using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the
6492 value of a section relative symbol. On the other hand, an absolute
6493 symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link
6494 operations.
6495
6496 Some terms in linker expressions are addresses. This is true of
6497 section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
6498 address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and
6499 @code{SEGMENT_START}. Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin
6500 functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}.
6501 One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")}
6502 (@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated
6503 differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older
6504 versions of @code{ld}. Expressions appearing outside an output
6505 section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses.
6506 Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat
6507 absolute symbols as numbers. If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is
6508 given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers
6509 everywhere.
6510
6511 In the following simple example,
6512
6513 @smallexample
6514 @group
6515 SECTIONS
6516 @{
6517 . = 0x100;
6518 __executable_start = 0x100;
6519 .data :
6520 @{
6521 . = 0x10;
6522 __data_start = 0x10;
6523 *(.data)
6524 @}
6525 @dots{}
6526 @}
6527 @end group
6528 @end smallexample
6529
6530 both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute
6531 address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and
6532 @code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data}
6533 section in the second two assignments.
6534
6535 For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
6536 addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
6537
6538 @itemize @bullet
6539 @item
6540 Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
6541 operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
6542 absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
6543 @item
6544 Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two
6545 relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address
6546 and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es).
6547 @item
6548 Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not
6549 in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute
6550 address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address
6551 before applying the operator.
6552 @end itemize
6553
6554 The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
6555
6556 @itemize @bullet
6557 @item
6558 An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
6559 @item
6560 The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number.
6561 @item
6562 The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
6563 relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
6564 (after above conversions) is also a number when
6565 @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition
6566 but an absolute address otherwise.
6567 @item
6568 The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
6569 relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
6570 section as the relative operand(s).
6571 @item
6572 The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
6573 conversions) is an absolute address.
6574 @end itemize
6575
6576 You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression
6577 to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative. For example, to
6578 create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
6579 section @samp{.data}:
6580 @smallexample
6581 SECTIONS
6582 @{
6583 .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @}
6584 @}
6585 @end smallexample
6586 @noindent
6587 If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the
6588 @samp{.data} section.
6589
6590 Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this
6591 particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
6592
6593 @node Builtin Functions
6594 @subsection Builtin Functions
6595 @cindex functions in expressions
6596 The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
6597 use in linker script expressions.
6598
6599 @table @code
6600 @item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6601 @kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6602 @cindex expression, absolute
6603 Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value
6604 of the expression @var{exp}. Primarily useful to assign an absolute
6605 value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are
6606 normally section relative. @xref{Expression Section}.
6607
6608 @item ADDR(@var{section})
6609 @kindex ADDR(@var{section})
6610 @cindex section address in expression
6611 Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}. Your
6612 script must previously have defined the location of that section. In
6613 the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and
6614 @code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that
6615 @code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while
6616 the other two will be absolute:
6617 @smallexample
6618 @group
6619 SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6620 .output1 :
6621 @{
6622 start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
6623 @dots{}
6624 @}
6625 .output :
6626 @{
6627 symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
6628 symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
6629 @}
6630 @dots{} @}
6631 @end group
6632 @end smallexample
6633
6634 @item ALIGN(@var{align})
6635 @itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6636 @kindex ALIGN(@var{align})
6637 @kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6638 @cindex round up location counter
6639 @cindex align location counter
6640 @cindex round up expression
6641 @cindex align expression
6642 Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned
6643 to the next @var{align} boundary. The single operand @code{ALIGN}
6644 doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does
6645 arithmetic on it. The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary
6646 expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is
6647 equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}).
6648
6649 Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the
6650 next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
6651 variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the
6652 input sections:
6653 @smallexample
6654 @group
6655 SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6656 .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{
6657 *(.data)
6658 variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
6659 @}
6660 @dots{} @}
6661 @end group
6662 @end smallexample
6663 @noindent
6664 The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of
6665 a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of
6666 a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}). The second use
6667 of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol.
6668
6669 The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}.
6670
6671 @item ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6672 @kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6673 @cindex section alignment
6674 Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6675 been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6676 evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6677 the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the first
6678 value in that section.
6679 @smallexample
6680 @group
6681 SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6682 .output @{
6683 LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
6684 @dots{}
6685 @}
6686 @dots{} @}
6687 @end group
6688 @end smallexample
6689
6690 @item BLOCK(@var{exp})
6691 @kindex BLOCK(@var{exp})
6692 This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker
6693 scripts. It is most often seen when setting the address of an output
6694 section.
6695
6696 @item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6697 @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6698 This is equivalent to either
6699 @smallexample
6700 (ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1)))
6701 @end smallexample
6702 or
6703 @smallexample
6704 (ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize})
6705 + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize})))
6706 @end smallexample
6707 @noindent
6708 depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages
6709 for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and
6710 @code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not.
6711 If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime
6712 memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted
6713 bytes in the on-disk file.
6714
6715 This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in
6716 any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script.
6717 @var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should
6718 be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still
6719 running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}. Note however
6720 that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system
6721 page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}.
6722
6723 @noindent
6724 Example:
6725 @smallexample
6726 . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
6727 @end smallexample
6728
6729 @item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6730 @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6731 This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}
6732 evaluation purposes.
6733
6734 @smallexample
6735 . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
6736 @end smallexample
6737
6738 @item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6739 @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6740 This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when
6741 @samp{-z relro} option is used.
6742 When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END}
6743 does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that
6744 @var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize}
6745 argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}. If present in the linker
6746 script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and
6747 @code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}. Evaluates to the second argument plus any
6748 padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to
6749 section alignment.
6750
6751 @smallexample
6752 . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
6753 @end smallexample
6754
6755 @item DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6756 @kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6757 @cindex symbol defaults
6758 Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is
6759 defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
6760 return 0. You can use this function to provide
6761 default values for symbols. For example, the following script fragment
6762 shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in
6763 the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already
6764 existed, its value is preserved:
6765
6766 @smallexample
6767 @group
6768 SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6769 .text : @{
6770 begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
6771 @dots{}
6772 @}
6773 @dots{}
6774 @}
6775 @end group
6776 @end smallexample
6777
6778 @item LENGTH(@var{memory})
6779 @kindex LENGTH(@var{memory})
6780 Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6781
6782 @item LOADADDR(@var{section})
6783 @kindex LOADADDR(@var{section})
6784 @cindex section load address in expression
6785 Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}. (@pxref{Output
6786 Section LMA}).
6787
6788 @item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6789 @kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6790 Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity.
6791 @code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0.
6792
6793 @kindex MAX
6794 @item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6795 Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6796
6797 @kindex MIN
6798 @item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6799 Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6800
6801 @item NEXT(@var{exp})
6802 @kindex NEXT(@var{exp})
6803 @cindex unallocated address, next
6804 Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}.
6805 This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you
6806 use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the
6807 output file, the two functions are equivalent.
6808
6809 @item ORIGIN(@var{memory})
6810 @kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory})
6811 Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6812
6813 @item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
6814 @kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
6815 Return the base address of the named @var{segment}. If an explicit
6816 value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
6817 @samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
6818 will be @var{default}. At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option
6819 can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and
6820 ``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment
6821 name.
6822
6823 @item SIZEOF(@var{section})
6824 @kindex SIZEOF(@var{section})
6825 @cindex section size
6826 Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6827 been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6828 evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6829 @code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical values:
6830 @smallexample
6831 @group
6832 SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6833 .output @{
6834 .start = . ;
6835 @dots{}
6836 .end = . ;
6837 @}
6838 symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
6839 symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
6840 @dots{} @}
6841 @end group
6842 @end smallexample
6843
6844 @item SIZEOF_HEADERS
6845 @itemx sizeof_headers
6846 @kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS
6847 @cindex header size
6848 Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers. This is
6849 information which appears at the start of the output file. You can use
6850 this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you
6851 choose, to facilitate paging.
6852
6853 @cindex not enough room for program headers
6854 @cindex program headers, not enough room
6855 When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
6856 @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the
6857 number of program headers before it has determined all the section
6858 addresses and sizes. If the linker later discovers that it needs
6859 additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough
6860 room for program headers}. To avoid this error, you must avoid using
6861 the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker
6862 script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or
6863 you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS}
6864 command (@pxref{PHDRS}).
6865 @end table
6866
6867 @node Implicit Linker Scripts
6868 @section Implicit Linker Scripts
6869 @cindex implicit linker scripts
6870 If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
6871 an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
6872 linker script. If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
6873 linker will report an error.
6874
6875 An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
6876
6877 Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
6878 assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION}
6879 commands.
6880
6881 Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read
6882 at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was
6883 read. This can affect archive searching.
6884
6885 @ifset GENERIC
6886 @node Machine Dependent
6887 @chapter Machine Dependent Features
6888
6889 @cindex machine dependencies
6890 @command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following
6891 sections describe them. Machines where @command{ld} has no additional
6892 functionality are not listed.
6893
6894 @menu
6895 @ifset H8300
6896 * H8/300:: @command{ld} and the H8/300
6897 @end ifset
6898 @ifset M68HC11
6899 * M68HC11/68HC12:: @code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
6900 @end ifset
6901 @ifset ARM
6902 * ARM:: @command{ld} and the ARM family
6903 @end ifset
6904 @ifset HPPA
6905 * HPPA ELF32:: @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF
6906 @end ifset
6907 @ifset M68K
6908 * M68K:: @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
6909 @end ifset
6910 @ifset MIPS
6911 * MIPS:: @command{ld} and the MIPS family
6912 @end ifset
6913 @ifset MMIX
6914 * MMIX:: @command{ld} and MMIX
6915 @end ifset
6916 @ifset MSP430
6917 * MSP430:: @command{ld} and MSP430
6918 @end ifset
6919 @ifset NDS32
6920 * NDS32:: @command{ld} and NDS32
6921 @end ifset
6922 @ifset NIOSII
6923 * Nios II:: @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
6924 @end ifset
6925 @ifset POWERPC
6926 * PowerPC ELF32:: @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
6927 @end ifset
6928 @ifset POWERPC64
6929 * PowerPC64 ELF64:: @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
6930 @end ifset
6931 @ifset S/390
6932 * S/390 ELF:: @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
6933 @end ifset
6934 @ifset SPU
6935 * SPU ELF:: @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
6936 @end ifset
6937 @ifset TICOFF
6938 * TI COFF:: @command{ld} and TI COFF
6939 @end ifset
6940 @ifset WIN32
6941 * WIN32:: @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
6942 @end ifset
6943 @ifset XTENSA
6944 * Xtensa:: @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors
6945 @end ifset
6946 @end menu
6947 @end ifset
6948
6949 @ifset H8300
6950 @ifclear GENERIC
6951 @raisesections
6952 @end ifclear
6953
6954 @node H8/300
6955 @section @command{ld} and the H8/300
6956
6957 @cindex H8/300 support
6958 For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when
6959 you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
6960
6961 @table @emph
6962 @cindex relaxing on H8/300
6963 @item relaxing address modes
6964 @command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
6965 targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
6966 program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
6967 respectively.
6968
6969 @cindex synthesizing on H8/300
6970 @item synthesizing instructions
6971 @c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S
6972 @command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the
6973 sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
6974 page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form.
6975 (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into
6976 @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the
6977 top page of memory).
6978
6979 @command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register
6980 indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
6981 displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use
6982 the 16-bit displacement form. (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b
6983 @code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx}
6984 whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer
6985 range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld).
6986
6987 @item bit manipulation instructions
6988 @command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr,
6989 biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor}
6990 which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
6991 page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form.
6992 (That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into
6993 @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
6994 the top page of memory).
6995
6996 @item system control instructions
6997 @command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the
6998 32 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
6999 changes them to use 16 bit address form.
7000 (That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into
7001 @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
7002 the top page of memory).
7003 @end table
7004
7005 @ifclear GENERIC
7006 @lowersections
7007 @end ifclear
7008 @end ifset
7009
7010 @ifclear GENERIC
7011 @ifset Renesas
7012 @c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned
7013 @c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please.
7014 @node Renesas
7015 @chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips
7016
7017 @command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H,
7018 H8/500, and SH chips. No special features, commands, or command-line
7019 options are required for these chips.
7020 @end ifset
7021 @end ifclear
7022
7023 @ifset ARM
7024 @ifclear GENERIC
7025 @raisesections
7026 @end ifclear
7027
7028 @ifset M68HC11
7029 @ifclear GENERIC
7030 @raisesections
7031 @end ifclear
7032
7033 @node M68HC11/68HC12
7034 @section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7035
7036 @cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support
7037
7038 @subsection Linker Relaxation
7039
7040 For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global
7041 optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7042
7043 @table @emph
7044 @cindex relaxing on M68HC11
7045 @item relaxing address modes
7046 @command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7047 targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7048 program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7049 respectively.
7050
7051 @command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
7052 transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
7053 page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
7054
7055 @item relaxing gcc instruction group
7056 When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group
7057 of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
7058 addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or
7059 @code{bset} instructions.
7060
7061 @end table
7062
7063 @subsection Trampoline Generation
7064
7065 @cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11
7066 @cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12
7067 For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to
7068 call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker
7069 will also change the relocation to some far function to use the
7070 trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the
7071 case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact
7072 point to the function trampoline.
7073
7074 @ifclear GENERIC
7075 @lowersections
7076 @end ifclear
7077 @end ifset
7078
7079 @node ARM
7080 @section @command{ld} and the ARM family
7081
7082 @cindex ARM interworking support
7083 @kindex --support-old-code
7084 For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
7085 between ARM and Thumb code. These stubs only work with code that has
7086 been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command
7087 line option. If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
7088 libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
7089 option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be
7090 given to the linker. This will make it generate larger stub functions
7091 which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code. Note, however,
7092 the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
7093 non-interworking aware Thumb code.
7094
7095 @cindex thumb entry point
7096 @cindex entry point, thumb
7097 @kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry}
7098 The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic
7099 @samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.
7100 But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be
7101 branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start
7102 executing in Thumb mode straight away.
7103
7104 @cindex PE import table prefixing
7105 @kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables
7106 The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that
7107 the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
7108 element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
7109 import tables. By default this option is turned off.
7110
7111 @cindex BE8
7112 @kindex --be8
7113 The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format
7114 executables. This option is only valid when linking big-endian
7115 objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB}
7116 option. The resulting image will contain big-endian data and
7117 little-endian code.
7118
7119 @cindex TARGET1
7120 @kindex --target1-rel
7121 @kindex --target1-abs
7122 The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the
7123 @samp{.init_array} section. It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32}
7124 or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target. The @samp{--target1-rel}
7125 and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default.
7126
7127 @cindex TARGET2
7128 @kindex --target2=@var{type}
7129 The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the
7130 @samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation. Valid values for @samp{type}, their
7131 meanings, and target defaults are as follows:
7132 @table @samp
7133 @item rel
7134 @samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
7135 @item abs
7136 @samp{R_ARM_ABS32} (arm*-*-symbianelf)
7137 @item got-rel
7138 @samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
7139 @end table
7140
7141 @cindex FIX_V4BX
7142 @kindex --fix-v4bx
7143 The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF
7144 specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
7145 interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but
7146 also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects.
7147
7148 In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the
7149 linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as
7150 @code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction.
7151
7152 In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7153 relocations are ignored.
7154
7155 @cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
7156 @kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking
7157 Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7158 relocations with a branch to the following veneer:
7159
7160 @smallexample
7161 TST rM, #1
7162 MOVEQ PC, rM
7163 BX Rn
7164 @end smallexample
7165
7166 This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores
7167 and are still interworking safe. Note that the above veneer clobbers the
7168 condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases.
7169
7170 @cindex USE_BLX
7171 @kindex --use-blx
7172 The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb
7173 BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various
7174 situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb
7175 code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before
7176 each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
7177
7178 This option is enabled implicitly for SymbianOS, so there is no need to
7179 specify it if you are using that target.
7180
7181 @cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX
7182 @kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix
7183 The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a
7184 bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
7185 instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code)
7186 to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before
7187 the support code can read the intended values.
7188
7189 The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
7190 intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register
7191 and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two
7192 intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects
7193 full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if
7194 you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details.
7195
7196 If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can
7197 enable this workaround by specifying the linker option
7198 @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar
7199 mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using
7200 vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is
7201 @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}.
7202
7203 If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7204 potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7205 such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
7206 first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
7207 instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
7208 the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
7209 are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
7210
7211 @cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround
7212 @kindex --fix-arm1176
7213 @kindex --no-fix-arm1176
7214 The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum
7215 in certain ARM1176 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you
7216 are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier. It can be disabled
7217 unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}.
7218
7219 Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
7220 Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at:
7221 http://infocenter.arm.com/.
7222
7223 @cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround
7224 @kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360
7225
7226 The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time
7227 workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of
7228 the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx). When accessing
7229 off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more,
7230 the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort. These are only
7231 core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access:
7232 integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM,
7233 VPOP. Stores are not affected.
7234
7235 The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the
7236 necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words.
7237
7238 The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use
7239 @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}. If you know you are using buggy
7240 STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the
7241 linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent
7242 @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}.
7243
7244 If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7245 potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7246 such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists in a
7247 replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a
7248 branch back to the subsequent instruction. The original instruction is
7249 then replaced with a branch to the veneer.
7250
7251 The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for
7252 the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC.
7253
7254 The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when
7255 they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed
7256 there. In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7257 occurs.
7258
7259 The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a
7260 PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too
7261 large. In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code
7262 cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7263 occurs.
7264
7265 @cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING
7266 @kindex --no-enum-size-warning
7267 The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7268 warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7269 enumeration size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7270 linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another
7271 using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will
7272 not be diagnosed.
7273
7274 @cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING
7275 @kindex --no-wchar-size-warning
7276 The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7277 warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7278 @code{wchar_t} size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7279 linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another
7280 using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed.
7281
7282 @cindex PIC_VENEER
7283 @kindex --pic-veneer
7284 The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
7285 ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary
7286 is not PIC. This avoids problems on uClinux targets where
7287 @samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries.
7288
7289 @cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE
7290 @kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7291 The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
7292 code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
7293 perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away. The
7294 placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
7295 controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}.
7296 The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
7297 duplicate stubs, increasing the code size. The linker will try to
7298 group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
7299 code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
7300 where they should be placed.
7301
7302 The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the
7303 @option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are
7304 placed. If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first
7305 branch that needs them. If it is positive then the stubs can be
7306 placed either before or after the branches that need them. If the
7307 value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose
7308 exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics.
7309 A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the
7310 linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes
7311 from the input sections.
7312
7313 The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is
7314 @samp{N = +1}.
7315
7316 Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
7317 only, because it relies on object files properties not present
7318 otherwise.
7319
7320 @cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround
7321 @kindex --fix-cortex-a8
7322 @kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8
7323 The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile. It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}.
7324
7325 The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code. Please contact ARM for further details.
7326
7327 @cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround
7328 @kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769
7329 @kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769
7330 The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors. The workaround is disabled by default. It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}.
7331
7332 Please contact ARM for further details.
7333
7334 @kindex --merge-exidx-entries
7335 @kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
7336 @cindex Merging exidx entries
7337 The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
7338
7339 @kindex --long-plt
7340 @cindex 32-bit PLT entries
7341 The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries
7342 which support up to 4Gb of code. The default is to use 12 byte PLT
7343 entries which only support 512Mb of code.
7344
7345 @kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs
7346 @cindex AArch64 rela addend
7347 The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply
7348 link-time values for dynamic relocations.
7349
7350 @cindex Placement of SG veneers
7351 All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}.
7352 Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option
7353 @samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these
7354 veneers in memory.
7355
7356 @kindex --cmse-implib
7357 @cindex Secure gateway import library
7358 The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries
7359 specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are
7360 secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure
7361 executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions.
7362
7363 @kindex --in-implib=@var{file}
7364 @cindex Input import library
7365 The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols
7366 must keep the same address in the executable being produced. A warning is
7367 given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced
7368 in the executable that should be listed in its import library. Otherwise, if
7369 @samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import
7370 library. A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import
7371 library have disappeared from the executable. This option is only effective
7372 for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is
7373 specified.
7374
7375 @ifclear GENERIC
7376 @lowersections
7377 @end ifclear
7378 @end ifset
7379
7380 @ifset HPPA
7381 @ifclear GENERIC
7382 @raisesections
7383 @end ifclear
7384
7385 @node HPPA ELF32
7386 @section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
7387 @cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs
7388 @kindex --multi-subspace
7389 When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate
7390 import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.
7391 The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export
7392 stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with
7393 multiple sub-spaces.
7394
7395 @cindex HPPA stub grouping
7396 @kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7397 Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in
7398 stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7399 @samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7400 sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7401 a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7402 the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7403 conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7404 prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7405 A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7406 branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7407 @samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7408 @command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7409 detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7410 positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7411
7412 Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7413 single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7414 create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7415 large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7416
7417 @ifclear GENERIC
7418 @lowersections
7419 @end ifclear
7420 @end ifset
7421
7422 @ifset M68K
7423 @ifclear GENERIC
7424 @raisesections
7425 @end ifclear
7426
7427 @node M68K
7428 @section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7429
7430 @cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation
7431 @kindex --got=@var{type}
7432 The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.
7433 The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and
7434 @samp{target}. When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses
7435 the default GOT generation scheme for the current target.
7436 @samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with
7437 entries only at non-negative offsets.
7438 @samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with
7439 entries at both negative and positive offsets. Not all environments
7440 support such GOTs.
7441 @samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the
7442 output file. All GOT references from a single input object
7443 file access the same GOT, but references from different input object
7444 files might access different GOTs. Not all environments support such GOTs.
7445
7446 @ifclear GENERIC
7447 @lowersections
7448 @end ifclear
7449 @end ifset
7450
7451 @ifset MIPS
7452 @ifclear GENERIC
7453 @raisesections
7454 @end ifclear
7455
7456 @node MIPS
7457 @section @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7458
7459 @cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection
7460 @kindex --insn32
7461 @kindex --no-insn32
7462 The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of
7463 microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that
7464 in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is
7465 used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings. By default
7466 or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used,
7467 including 16-bit ones where possible.
7468
7469 @cindex MIPS branch relocation check control
7470 @kindex --ignore-branch-isa
7471 @kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
7472 The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options
7473 control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions. If
7474 @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch
7475 relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation
7476 calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet
7477 relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX}
7478 instructions as the associated relocation is calculated. By default
7479 or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing
7480 the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error.
7481
7482 @ifclear GENERIC
7483 @lowersections
7484 @end ifclear
7485 @end ifset
7486
7487 @ifset MMIX
7488 @ifclear GENERIC
7489 @raisesections
7490 @end ifclear
7491
7492 @node MMIX
7493 @section @code{ld} and MMIX
7494 For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or
7495 @code{mmo} object files when linking. The simulator @code{mmix}
7496 understands the @code{mmo} format. The binutils @code{objcopy} utility
7497 can translate between the two formats.
7498
7499 There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section.
7500 Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
7501 registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols,
7502 equal to registers. In a final link, the start address of the
7503 @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated
7504 global register multiplied by 8. Register @code{$255} is not included in
7505 this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the
7506 symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files.
7507
7508 Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example
7509 @code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special.
7510 The default linker script uses these to set the default start address
7511 of a section.
7512
7513 Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section,
7514 are left out from an mmo file.
7515
7516 @ifclear GENERIC
7517 @lowersections
7518 @end ifclear
7519 @end ifset
7520
7521 @ifset MSP430
7522 @ifclear GENERIC
7523 @raisesections
7524 @end ifclear
7525
7526 @node MSP430
7527 @section @code{ld} and MSP430
7528 For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture. The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]}
7529 will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type. (To get a list of known MPUs
7530 just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker).
7531
7532 @cindex MSP430 extra sections
7533 The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific:
7534
7535 @table @code
7536 @item @samp{.vectors}
7537 Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
7538
7539 @item @samp{.bootloader}
7540 Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable). Any code
7541 in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7542
7543 @item @samp{.infomem}
7544 Defines an information memory section (if applicable). Any code in
7545 this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7546
7547 @item @samp{.infomemnobits}
7548 This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code
7549 in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
7550
7551 @item @samp{.noinit}
7552 Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section.
7553
7554 The last two sections are used by gcc.
7555 @end table
7556
7557 @table @option
7558 @cindex MSP430 Options
7559 @kindex --code-region
7560 @item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7561 This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The
7562 argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker
7563 using this option.
7564
7565 @kindex --data-region
7566 @item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7567 This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to
7568 [either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC
7569 for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option.
7570
7571 @kindex --disable-sec-transformation
7572 @item --disable-sec-transformation
7573 Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region}
7574 and @code{--data-region} options.
7575 This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC
7576 wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but
7577 not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects.
7578 @end table
7579
7580 @ifclear GENERIC
7581 @lowersections
7582 @end ifclear
7583 @end ifset
7584
7585 @ifset NDS32
7586 @ifclear GENERIC
7587 @raisesections
7588 @end ifclear
7589
7590 @node NDS32
7591 @section @code{ld} and NDS32
7592 @kindex relaxing on NDS32
7593 For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior. The linker
7594 relaxes objects according to these options.
7595
7596 @table @code
7597 @item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp}
7598 Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
7599
7600 @item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE}
7601 Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
7602
7603 @item @samp{--m[no-]ex9}
7604 Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
7605
7606 @item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE}
7607 Export the EX9 table after linking.
7608
7609 @item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE}
7610 Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
7611
7612 @item @samp{--mupdate-ex9}
7613 Update the existing EX9 table.
7614
7615 @item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM}
7616 Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
7617
7618 @item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware}
7619 Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
7620
7621 @item @samp{--m[no-]ifc}
7622 Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
7623
7624 @item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware}
7625 Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
7626 @end table
7627
7628 @ifclear GENERIC
7629 @lowersections
7630 @end ifclear
7631 @end ifset
7632
7633 @ifset NIOSII
7634 @ifclear GENERIC
7635 @raisesections
7636 @end ifclear
7637
7638 @node Nios II
7639 @section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7640 @cindex Nios II call relaxation
7641 @kindex --relax on Nios II
7642
7643 Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to
7644 transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
7645 which may result in @command{ld} giving
7646 @samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7647 The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of
7648 trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls
7649 outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range. These
7650 trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
7651 be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are
7652 larger than 256MB.
7653
7654 The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r}
7655 is also specified. You can disable trampoline generation by using the
7656 @option{--no-relax} linker option. You can also disable this optimization
7657 locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language
7658 source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at}
7659 register as a temporary.
7660
7661 Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler
7662 relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all}
7663 option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation.
7664
7665 @ifclear GENERIC
7666 @lowersections
7667 @end ifclear
7668 @end ifset
7669
7670 @ifset POWERPC
7671 @ifclear GENERIC
7672 @raisesections
7673 @end ifclear
7674
7675 @node PowerPC ELF32
7676 @section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7677 @cindex PowerPC long branches
7678 @kindex --relax on PowerPC
7679 Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
7680 displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving
7681 @samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7682 @samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access
7683 the entire 32-bit address space. These trampolines are inserted at
7684 section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input
7685 section exceeds 33M in size. You may combine @samp{-r} and
7686 @samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link. In that case
7687 both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
7688 considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
7689
7690 @cindex PowerPC ELF32 options
7691 @table @option
7692 @cindex PowerPC PLT
7693 @kindex --bss-plt
7694 @item --bss-plt
7695 Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that
7696 generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has
7697 the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
7698 writable and no writable section ever being executable. PowerPC
7699 @command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the
7700 PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
7701 compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}. @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old
7702 BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
7703
7704 @kindex --secure-plt
7705 @item --secure-plt
7706 @command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
7707 @samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically
7708 when linking non-PIC code. This option requests the new PLT and GOT
7709 layout. A warning will be given if some object file requires the old
7710 style BSS PLT.
7711
7712 @cindex PowerPC GOT
7713 @kindex --sdata-got
7714 @item --sdata-got
7715 The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
7716 sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement. The location of
7717 @code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized
7718 section while the old PLT is uninitialized. The reason for the
7719 @code{.got} change is more subtle: The new placement allows
7720 @code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with
7721 @samp{-z relro -z now}. However, this placement means that
7722 @code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the
7723 PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT
7724 pointer. @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement. PowerPC
7725 GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is
7726 really only useful for other compilers that may do so.
7727
7728 @cindex PowerPC stub symbols
7729 @kindex --emit-stub-syms
7730 @item --emit-stub-syms
7731 This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7732 symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7733
7734 @cindex PowerPC TLS optimization
7735 @kindex --no-tls-optimize
7736 @item --no-tls-optimize
7737 PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
7738 sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
7739 disable the optimization.
7740 @end table
7741
7742 @ifclear GENERIC
7743 @lowersections
7744 @end ifclear
7745 @end ifset
7746
7747 @ifset POWERPC64
7748 @ifclear GENERIC
7749 @raisesections
7750 @end ifclear
7751
7752 @node PowerPC64 ELF64
7753 @section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7754
7755 @cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options
7756 @table @option
7757 @cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping
7758 @kindex --stub-group-size
7759 @item --stub-group-size
7760 Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs and TOC adjusting stubs are placed
7761 by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7762 @samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7763 sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7764 a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7765 the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7766 conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7767 prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7768 A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7769 branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7770 @samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7771 @command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7772 detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7773 positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7774
7775 Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7776 single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7777 create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7778 large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7779
7780 @cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols
7781 @kindex --emit-stub-syms
7782 @item --emit-stub-syms
7783 This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7784 symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7785
7786 @cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols
7787 @kindex --dotsyms
7788 @kindex --no-dotsyms
7789 @item --dotsyms
7790 @itemx --no-dotsyms
7791 These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns
7792 in a version script. Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
7793 function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a
7794 code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}). To
7795 properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs
7796 to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}. The option
7797 @samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required
7798 dot-prefixed patterns. Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this
7799 feature.
7800
7801 @cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions
7802 @kindex --save-restore-funcs
7803 @kindex --no-save-restore-funcs
7804 @item --save-restore-funcs
7805 @itemx --no-save-restore-funcs
7806 These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically
7807 provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by
7808 @samp{-Os} code. The default is to provide any such referenced
7809 function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable
7810 link.
7811
7812 @cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization
7813 @kindex --no-tls-optimize
7814 @item --no-tls-optimize
7815 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
7816 sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
7817 disable the optimization.
7818
7819 @cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization
7820 @kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize
7821 @kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
7822 @kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave
7823 @kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave
7824 @item --tls-get-addr-optimize
7825 @itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
7826 These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special
7827 stub to call __tls_get_addr. PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support
7828 an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to
7829 @code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special
7830 stub without calling in to glibc. By default the linker enables
7831 generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of
7832 __tls_get_addr_opt.
7833 Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do
7834 much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking
7835 an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it
7836 will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc.
7837 @option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves
7838 and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc. Normally,
7839 this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc.
7840 Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt.
7841 @option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the
7842 register saves.
7843
7844 @cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization
7845 @kindex --no-opd-optimize
7846 @item --no-opd-optimize
7847 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries
7848 corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by
7849 the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}.
7850 Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization.
7851
7852 @cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing
7853 @kindex --non-overlapping-opd
7854 @item --non-overlapping-opd
7855 Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
7856 @code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
7857 the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next
7858 entry. This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
7859
7860 @cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization
7861 @kindex --no-toc-optimize
7862 @item --no-toc-optimize
7863 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section
7864 entries. Such entries are detected by examining relocations that
7865 reference the TOC in code sections. A reloc in a deleted code section
7866 marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section
7867 marks a TOC word as needed. Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
7868 relocs are also examined. TOC words marked as both needed and
7869 unneeded will of course be kept. TOC words without any referencing
7870 reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
7871 discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word. This works
7872 reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly
7873 code is used to insert TOC entries. Use this option to disable the
7874 optimization.
7875
7876 @cindex PowerPC64 inline PLT call optimization
7877 @kindex --no-inline-optimize
7878 @item --no-inline-optimize
7879 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally replaces inline PLT call sequences
7880 marked with @code{R_PPC64_PLTSEQ}, @code{R_PPC64_PLTCALL},
7881 @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_HA} and @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS} relocations by
7882 a number of @code{nop}s and a direct call when the function is defined
7883 locally and can't be overridden by some other definition. This option
7884 disables that optimization.
7885
7886 @cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC
7887 @kindex --no-multi-toc
7888 @item --no-multi-toc
7889 If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or
7890 @code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
7891 where TOC
7892 entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2. This limits the
7893 total TOC size to 64K. PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by
7894 grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its
7895 TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group
7896 calls. @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot
7897 help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds
7898 64K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}.
7899 Use this option to turn off this feature.
7900
7901 @cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting
7902 @kindex --no-toc-sort
7903 @item --no-toc-sort
7904 By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
7905 happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are
7906 placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated
7907 with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections
7908 referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
7909 @code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options. Doing this
7910 results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC. Use this option to turn
7911 off this feature.
7912
7913 @cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment
7914 @kindex --plt-align
7915 @kindex --no-plt-align
7916 @item --plt-align
7917 @itemx --no-plt-align
7918 Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
7919 aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two
7920 boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}. A negative value may be
7921 specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the
7922 specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries
7923 if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary). By default
7924 PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries.
7925
7926 @cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain
7927 @kindex --plt-static-chain
7928 @kindex --no-plt-static-chain
7929 @item --plt-static-chain
7930 @itemx --no-plt-static-chain
7931 Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
7932 chain pointer (r11). @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static
7933 chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
7934
7935 @cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety
7936 @kindex --plt-thread-safe
7937 @kindex --no-plt-thread-safe
7938 @item --plt-thread-safe
7939 @itemx --no-plt-thread-safe
7940 With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using
7941 lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have
7942 another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong
7943 order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using
7944 memory write barriers. To avoid this we need some sort of read
7945 barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1. By default, @code{ld}
7946 looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if
7947 seen, adds the necessary barriers. Use these options to change the
7948 default behaviour.
7949
7950 @cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization
7951 @kindex --plt-localentry
7952 @kindex --no-plt-localentry
7953 @item --plt-localentry
7954 @itemx --no-localentry
7955 ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point,
7956 ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2
7957 (the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return.
7958 Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2
7959 or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small
7960 functions. The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction
7961 in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol
7962 interposition failures. Also, minor changes in a shared library,
7963 including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0
7964 to become localentry:8. This will result in a dynamic loader
7965 complaint and failure to run. The option is experimental, use with
7966 care. @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default.
7967
7968 @cindex PowerPC64 Power10 stubs
7969 @kindex --power10-stubs
7970 @kindex --no-power10-stubs
7971 @item --power10-stubs
7972 @itemx --no-power10-stubs
7973 When PowerPC64 @command{ld} links input object files containing
7974 relocations used on power10 prefixed instructions it normally creates
7975 linkage stubs (PLT call and long branch) using power10 instructions
7976 for @code{@@notoc} PLT calls where @code{r2} is not known. The
7977 power10 notoc stubs are smaller and faster, so are preferred for
7978 power10. @option{--power10-stubs} and @option{--no-power10-stubs}
7979 allow you to override the linker's selection of stub instructions.
7980 @option{--power10-stubs=auto} allows the user to select the default
7981 auto mode.
7982 @end table
7983
7984 @ifclear GENERIC
7985 @lowersections
7986 @end ifclear
7987 @end ifset
7988
7989 @ifset S/390
7990 @ifclear GENERIC
7991 @raisesections
7992 @end ifclear
7993
7994 @node S/390 ELF
7995 @section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
7996
7997 @cindex S/390 ELF options
7998 @table @option
7999
8000 @cindex S/390
8001 @kindex --s390-pgste
8002 @item --s390-pgste
8003 This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE}
8004 segment. The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for
8005 binaries marked that way.
8006 @end table
8007
8008 @ifclear GENERIC
8009 @lowersections
8010 @end ifclear
8011 @end ifset
8012
8013 @ifset SPU
8014 @ifclear GENERIC
8015 @raisesections
8016 @end ifclear
8017
8018 @node SPU ELF
8019 @section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
8020
8021 @cindex SPU ELF options
8022 @table @option
8023
8024 @cindex SPU plugins
8025 @kindex --plugin
8026 @item --plugin
8027 This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
8028
8029 @cindex SPU overlays
8030 @kindex --no-overlays
8031 @item --no-overlays
8032 Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay
8033 regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
8034 @command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager. This option
8035 turns off all this special overlay handling.
8036
8037 @cindex SPU overlay stub symbols
8038 @kindex --emit-stub-syms
8039 @item --emit-stub-syms
8040 This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local
8041 symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8042
8043 @cindex SPU extra overlay stubs
8044 @kindex --extra-overlay-stubs
8045 @item --extra-overlay-stubs
8046 This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all
8047 function calls out of overlay regions. Normally stubs are not added
8048 on calls to non-overlay regions.
8049
8050 @cindex SPU local store size
8051 @kindex --local-store=lo:hi
8052 @item --local-store=lo:hi
8053 @command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in
8054 the address range 0 to 256k. This option may be used to change the
8055 range. Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}.
8056
8057 @cindex SPU
8058 @kindex --stack-analysis
8059 @item --stack-analysis
8060 SPU local store space is limited. Over-allocation of stack space
8061 unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
8062 under-allocation results in runtime failures. If given this option,
8063 @command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
8064 @command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to
8065 determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues
8066 for stack adjusting instructions. A call-graph is created by looking
8067 for relocations on branch instructions. The graph is then searched
8068 for the maximum stack usage path. Note that this analysis does not
8069 find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion
8070 and other cycles in the call graph. Stack usage may be
8071 under-estimated if your code makes such calls. Also, stack usage for
8072 dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected. If a link map
8073 is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage
8074 and calls will be given.
8075
8076 @cindex SPU
8077 @kindex --emit-stack-syms
8078 @item --emit-stack-syms
8079 This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result
8080 in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.
8081 These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global
8082 functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static
8083 functions. @code{<number>} is the section id in hex. The value of
8084 such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function.
8085 The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding
8086 @code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}.
8087 @end table
8088
8089 @ifclear GENERIC
8090 @lowersections
8091 @end ifclear
8092 @end ifset
8093
8094 @ifset TICOFF
8095 @ifclear GENERIC
8096 @raisesections
8097 @end ifclear
8098
8099 @node TI COFF
8100 @section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
8101 @cindex TI COFF versions
8102 @kindex --format=@var{version}
8103 The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various
8104 TI COFF versions. The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are
8105 also supported. The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order
8106 format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output
8107 header format depends on the default specified by the specific target.
8108
8109 @ifclear GENERIC
8110 @lowersections
8111 @end ifclear
8112 @end ifset
8113
8114 @ifset WIN32
8115 @ifclear GENERIC
8116 @raisesections
8117 @end ifclear
8118
8119 @node WIN32
8120 @section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
8121
8122 This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues.
8123 See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the
8124 command-line options mentioned here.
8125
8126 @table @emph
8127 @cindex import libraries
8128 @item import libraries
8129 The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
8130 libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's. They are
8131 regular static archives and are handled as any other static
8132 archive. The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific
8133 support for creating such libraries provided with the
8134 @samp{--out-implib} command-line option.
8135
8136 @item exporting DLL symbols
8137 @cindex exporting DLL symbols
8138 The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
8139
8140 @table @emph
8141 @item using auto-export functionality
8142 @cindex using auto-export functionality
8143 By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality,
8144 which is controlled by the following command-line options:
8145
8146 @itemize
8147 @item --export-all-symbols [This is the default]
8148 @item --exclude-symbols
8149 @item --exclude-libs
8150 @item --exclude-modules-for-implib
8151 @item --version-script
8152 @end itemize
8153
8154 When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local
8155 (global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few
8156 symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries. As it will
8157 often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
8158 private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line
8159 options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for
8160 exporting. The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the
8161 final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
8162
8163 If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the
8164 command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled}
8165 if either of the following are true:
8166
8167 @itemize
8168 @item A DEF file is used.
8169 @item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
8170 @end itemize
8171
8172 @item using a DEF file
8173 @cindex using a DEF file
8174 Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file. A DEF file is
8175 an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be
8176 exported when a dll is created. Usually it is named @samp{<dll
8177 name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's
8178 command line. The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}.
8179
8180 @example
8181 gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
8182 @end example
8183
8184 Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the
8185 @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8186
8187 Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}:
8188
8189 @example
8190 LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
8191
8192 EXPORTS
8193 foo
8194 bar
8195 _bar = bar
8196 another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
8197 var1 DATA
8198 doo = foo == foo2
8199 eoo DATA == var1
8200 @end example
8201
8202 This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven
8203 symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an
8204 alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved
8205 by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for
8206 @code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol
8207 @code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in
8208 export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name
8209 in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export
8210 symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}.
8211
8212 The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal}
8213 name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix,
8214 the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended.
8215
8216 When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a
8217 library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of
8218 @code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default
8219 executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended.
8220
8221 With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional
8222 specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a
8223 non-default base address for the image.
8224
8225 If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor @code{NAME <name>} is specified,
8226 or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the
8227 filename specified on the command line.
8228
8229 The complete specification of an export symbol is:
8230
8231 @example
8232 EXPORTS
8233 ( ( ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
8234 | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
8235 [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
8236 @end example
8237
8238 Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares
8239 @samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares
8240 @samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol
8241 @samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}.
8242 Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
8243 @samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used
8244 string in import/export table for the symbol.
8245
8246 The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
8247
8248 @code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table. It
8249 will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified
8250 by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the
8251 linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import
8252 library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified.
8253
8254 @code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function.
8255 The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as
8256 the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as
8257 @code{*_imp__foo}).
8258
8259 @code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as
8260 well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the
8261 read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the
8262 variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add
8263 the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the
8264 extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the
8265 application will behave unexpectedly.
8266
8267 @code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put
8268 it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The
8269 symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress}
8270 API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to
8271 the DLL without an import library.
8272
8273 See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of
8274 other DEF file statements
8275
8276 @cindex creating a DEF file
8277 While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file
8278 with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option.
8279
8280 @item Using decorations
8281 @cindex Using decorations
8282 Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code
8283 itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is
8284 declared as:
8285
8286 @example
8287 __declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
8288 __declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
8289 @end example
8290
8291 All such symbols will be exported from the DLL. If, however,
8292 any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in
8293 this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless
8294 the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8295
8296 Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not}
8297 decorate them with dllexport. Instead, they should use dllimport,
8298 instead:
8299
8300 @example
8301 __declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
8302 __declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
8303 @end example
8304
8305 This complicates the structure of library header files, because
8306 when included by the library itself the header must declare the
8307 variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client
8308 code the header must declare them as dllimport. There are a number
8309 of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can
8310 omit the __declspec() declaration completely. See
8311 @samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more
8312 information.
8313 @end table
8314
8315 @cindex automatic data imports
8316 @item automatic data imports
8317 The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only
8318 by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the
8319 compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this
8320 issue. This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x
8321 code to these platforms, especially for large
8322 c++ libraries and applications. The auto-import feature, which was
8323 initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
8324 decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x
8325 platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import}
8326 command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw.
8327 The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to
8328 suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects
8329 trigger the feature's use.
8330
8331 auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
8332 additional assistance. Sometimes, you will see this message
8333
8334 "variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
8335 documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
8336
8337 The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error
8338 occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty.
8339 One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described
8340 below.
8341
8342 @cindex runtime pseudo-relocation
8343 For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes),
8344 object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an
8345 offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular
8346 field or public member, for instance. Unfortunately, the runtime loader used
8347 in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime
8348 without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.
8349 The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these
8350 references.
8351
8352 The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to
8353 be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references
8354 themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the
8355 runtime environment. Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and
8356 compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not. However, the
8357 support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will
8358 run without error on an older system.
8359
8360 @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly
8361 enabled as needed.
8362
8363 @cindex direct linking to a dll
8364 @item direct linking to a dll
8365 The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking,
8366 including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
8367 libraries. This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the
8368 traditional import library method, especially when linking large
8369 libraries or applications. When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each
8370 function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even
8371 though a single bfd could contain many exports. The overhead involved in
8372 storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
8373 tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly
8374 large or complex libraries when using import libs.
8375
8376 Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than
8377 @samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number
8378 of names to match each library. All that is needed from the developer's
8379 perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to
8380 select the dll instead of an import library.
8381
8382
8383 For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt
8384 to find, in the first directory of its search path,
8385
8386 @example
8387 libxxx.dll.a
8388 xxx.dll.a
8389 libxxx.a
8390 xxx.lib
8391 libxxx.lib
8392 cygxxx.dll (*)
8393 libxxx.dll
8394 xxx.dll
8395 @end example
8396
8397 before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
8398
8399 (*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll},
8400 where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option
8401 @samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec
8402 file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for
8403 @samp{cygxxx.dll}.
8404
8405 Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other
8406 @samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature. It
8407 was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the
8408 various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
8409 could coexist on the same machine.
8410
8411 The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for
8412 applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import
8413 libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
8414
8415 @example
8416 bin/
8417 cygxxx.dll
8418 lib/
8419 libxxx.dll.a (in case of dll's)
8420 libxxx.a (in case of static archive)
8421 @end example
8422
8423 Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
8424 done two ways:
8425
8426 1. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line
8427 @example
8428 gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
8429 @end example
8430
8431 However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names
8432 (@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies
8433 @samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version. Import libs are generally
8434 not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
8435
8436 2. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib}
8437 directory according to the above mentioned search pattern. This
8438 should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
8439 making the app/dll.
8440
8441 @example
8442 ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
8443 @end example
8444
8445 Then you can link without any make environment changes.
8446
8447 @example
8448 gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
8449 @end example
8450
8451 This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is
8452 perfectly legal
8453
8454 @example
8455 bin/
8456 cygxxx-5.dll
8457 lib/
8458 libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
8459 @end example
8460
8461 Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
8462 even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
8463 @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used.
8464
8465 Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably
8466 wonder why import libraries are used at all. There are three reasons:
8467
8468 1. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not}
8469 work with auto-imported data.
8470
8471 2. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the
8472 import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection
8473 symbols that point to the exports of a dll). Again, the import lib
8474 for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not
8475 possible to do this without an import lib.
8476
8477 3. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib. This is
8478 critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API)
8479 in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their
8480 stdcall-decorated assembly names.
8481
8482 So, import libs are not going away. But the ability to replace
8483 true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of)
8484 a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
8485 binutils makes available to the win32 developer. Given the
8486 massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
8487 requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
8488 will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
8489
8490 @item symbol aliasing
8491 @table @emph
8492 @item adding additional names
8493 Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names.
8494 A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be
8495 exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file
8496 when creating the dll. This will affect also the optional created
8497 import library. Consider the following DEF file:
8498
8499 @example
8500 LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8501
8502 EXPORTS
8503 foo
8504 _foo = foo
8505 @end example
8506
8507 The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}.
8508
8509 Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the
8510 source code using the "weak" attribute:
8511
8512 @example
8513 void foo () @{ /* Do something. */; @}
8514 void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
8515 @end example
8516
8517 See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak
8518 symbols.
8519
8520 @item renaming symbols
8521 Sometimes it is useful to rename exports. For instance, the cygwin
8522 kernel does this regularly. A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as
8523 @samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the
8524 DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is
8525 created). In the following example:
8526
8527 @example
8528 LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8529
8530 EXPORTS
8531 _foo = foo
8532 @end example
8533
8534 The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to
8535 @samp{_foo}.
8536 @end table
8537
8538 Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
8539 unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used.
8540 If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
8541 @emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols
8542 that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the
8543 @samp{--export-all-symbols} option. If you list only the
8544 renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols}
8545 to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and}
8546 the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported.
8547 In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them,
8548 which is probably not what you wanted.
8549
8550 @cindex weak externals
8551 @item weak externals
8552 The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called
8553 weak externals. When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not
8554 defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol. There
8555 are three variants of weak externals:
8556 @itemize
8557 @item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically
8558 called lazy externals.
8559 @item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries.
8560 This form is not presently implemented.
8561 @item No search; the symbol is an alias. This form is not presently
8562 implemented.
8563 @end itemize
8564 As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol
8565 are supported. If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol
8566 uses a default value.
8567
8568 @cindex aligned common symbols
8569 @item aligned common symbols
8570 As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the
8571 desired alignment for a common symbol. This information is conveyed from
8572 the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands
8573 carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized
8574 by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols. Native
8575 tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension,
8576 but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy
8577 warnings about unknown linker directives.
8578
8579 @end table
8580
8581 @ifclear GENERIC
8582 @lowersections
8583 @end ifclear
8584 @end ifset
8585
8586 @ifset XTENSA
8587 @ifclear GENERIC
8588 @raisesections
8589 @end ifclear
8590
8591 @node Xtensa
8592 @section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors
8593
8594 @cindex Xtensa processors
8595 The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
8596 @code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
8597 specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
8598 keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets. For
8599 example, with the command:
8600
8601 @smallexample
8602 SECTIONS
8603 @{
8604 .text : @{
8605 *(.literal .text)
8606 @}
8607 @}
8608 @end smallexample
8609
8610 @noindent
8611 @command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal}
8612 and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the
8613 literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets. A valid
8614 interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial
8615 group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of
8616 files. Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files
8617 and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow.
8618
8619 @cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa
8620 @cindex relaxing on Xtensa
8621 Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and
8622 provides two important link-time optimizations. The first optimization
8623 is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size. A redundant
8624 literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it
8625 will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
8626 location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
8627 the @code{L32R} instructions. The second optimization is to remove
8628 unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of
8629 @code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within
8630 range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions.
8631
8632 For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized
8633 to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}}
8634 instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R}
8635 instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R}
8636 instruction if it is not used for anything else. Removing the
8637 @code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially
8638 hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets.
8639 By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by
8640 switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent
8641 density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R}
8642 instruction that was removed. If code size is more important than
8643 performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the
8644 linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in
8645 a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness.
8646
8647 The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
8648 control the linker:
8649
8650 @cindex Xtensa options
8651 @table @option
8652 @item --size-opt
8653 When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size
8654 more than performance. With this option, the linker will not insert
8655 no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target
8656 alignment. There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to
8657 preserve the correctness of the code.
8658
8659 @item --abi-windowed
8660 @itemx --abi-call0
8661 Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code.
8662 PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object
8663 because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call
8664 conventions.
8665 Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section
8666 of the first input object.
8667 A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other
8668 or the chosen output object ABI.
8669 @end table
8670
8671 @ifclear GENERIC
8672 @lowersections
8673 @end ifclear
8674 @end ifset
8675
8676 @ifclear SingleFormat
8677 @node BFD
8678 @chapter BFD
8679
8680 @cindex back end
8681 @cindex object file management
8682 @cindex object formats available
8683 @kindex objdump -i
8684 The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
8685 These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
8686 object files whatever the object file format. A different object file
8687 format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
8688 it to the library. To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
8689 associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
8690 object file formats available. You can use @code{objdump -i}
8691 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to
8692 list all the formats available for your configuration.
8693
8694 @cindex BFD requirements
8695 @cindex requirements for BFD
8696 As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between
8697 several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing
8698 BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between
8699 formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not
8700 been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since
8701 BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care
8702 may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed.
8703
8704 One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in
8705 mind is the potential for information loss. There are two places where
8706 useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
8707 conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}.
8708
8709 @menu
8710 * BFD outline:: How it works: an outline of BFD
8711 @end menu
8712
8713 @node BFD outline
8714 @section How It Works: An Outline of BFD
8715 @cindex opening object files
8716 @include bfdsumm.texi
8717 @end ifclear
8718
8719 @node Reporting Bugs
8720 @chapter Reporting Bugs
8721 @cindex bugs in @command{ld}
8722 @cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld}
8723
8724 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable.
8725
8726 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or
8727 it may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is
8728 to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld}
8729 work better. Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of
8730 @command{ld}.
8731
8732 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
8733 information that enables us to fix the bug.
8734
8735 @menu
8736 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
8737 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
8738 @end menu
8739
8740 @node Bug Criteria
8741 @section Have You Found a Bug?
8742 @cindex bug criteria
8743
8744 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
8745
8746 @itemize @bullet
8747 @cindex fatal signal
8748 @cindex linker crash
8749 @cindex crash of linker
8750 @item
8751 If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
8752 @command{ld} bug. Reliable linkers never crash.
8753
8754 @cindex error on valid input
8755 @item
8756 If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
8757
8758 @cindex invalid input
8759 @item
8760 If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
8761 may be a bug. In the general case, the linker can not verify that
8762 object files are correct.
8763
8764 @item
8765 If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
8766 improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case.
8767 @end itemize
8768
8769 @node Bug Reporting
8770 @section How to Report Bugs
8771 @cindex bug reports
8772 @cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting
8773
8774 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu}
8775 products. If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we
8776 recommend you contact that organization first.
8777
8778 You can find contact information for many support companies and
8779 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
8780 distribution.
8781
8782 @ifset BUGURL
8783 Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to
8784 @value{BUGURL}.
8785 @end ifset
8786
8787 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
8788 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
8789 fact or leave it out, state it!
8790
8791 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
8792 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
8793 assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not
8794 matter. Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps
8795 the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the
8796 location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name
8797 were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker
8798 into doing the right thing despite the bug. Play it safe and give a
8799 specific, complete example. That is the easiest thing for you to do,
8800 and the most helpful.
8801
8802 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
8803 the bug if it is new to us. Therefore, always write your bug reports
8804 on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
8805
8806 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
8807 bell?'' This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless. We
8808 respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
8809 You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
8810
8811 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
8812
8813 @itemize @bullet
8814 @item
8815 The version of @command{ld}. @command{ld} announces it if you start it with
8816 the @samp{--version} argument.
8817
8818 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
8819 the bug in the current version of @command{ld}.
8820
8821 @item
8822 Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any
8823 patches made to the @code{BFD} library.
8824
8825 @item
8826 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
8827 version number.
8828
8829 @item
8830 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g.
8831 ``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
8832
8833 @item
8834 The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
8835 observe the bug. To guarantee you will not omit something important,
8836 list them all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is
8837 sufficient.
8838
8839 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
8840 and then we might not encounter the bug.
8841
8842 @item
8843 A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the
8844 bug. It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files
8845 provided that they are reasonably small. Say no more than 10K. For
8846 bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else
8847 state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever
8848 requests them. (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so
8849 we do not want to clog it up with large attachments). But small
8850 attachments are best.
8851
8852 If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using
8853 @code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
8854 object files. In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
8855 @code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files. Also say
8856 how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured.
8857
8858 @item
8859 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
8860 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
8861
8862 Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we
8863 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
8864 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
8865 a chance to make a mistake.
8866
8867 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
8868 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
8869 copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the
8870 C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might crash
8871 and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours
8872 fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us. If
8873 you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw
8874 any conclusion from our observations.
8875
8876 @item
8877 If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context
8878 diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or
8879 @samp{-p} option. Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.
8880 If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by
8881 context, not by line number.
8882
8883 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
8884 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
8885 @end itemize
8886
8887 Here are some things that are not necessary:
8888
8889 @itemize @bullet
8890 @item
8891 A description of the envelope of the bug.
8892
8893 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
8894 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
8895 changes will not affect it.
8896
8897 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
8898 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
8899 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
8900 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
8901
8902 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
8903 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
8904 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
8905 less time, and so on.
8906
8907 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
8908 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
8909
8910 @item
8911 A patch for the bug.
8912
8913 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
8914 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
8915 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
8916 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
8917
8918 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to
8919 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
8920 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be
8921 able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is
8922 fixed.
8923
8924 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
8925 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
8926 help us to understand.
8927
8928 @item
8929 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
8930
8931 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
8932 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
8933 @end itemize
8934
8935 @node MRI
8936 @appendix MRI Compatible Script Files
8937 @cindex MRI compatibility
8938 To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI
8939 linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an
8940 alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language
8941 described in @ref{Scripts}. MRI compatible linker scripts have a much
8942 simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with
8943 @command{ld}. @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI
8944 linker commands; these commands are described here.
8945
8946 In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object
8947 file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
8948 features to make use of them.
8949
8950 You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
8951 @samp{-c} command-line option.
8952
8953 Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
8954 command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
8955 blank lines are also allowed for punctuation). If a line of an
8956 MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld}
8957 issues a warning message, but continues processing the script.
8958
8959 Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments.
8960
8961 You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
8962 lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}.
8963 The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
8964
8965 @table @code
8966 @cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI)
8967 @item ABSOLUTE @var{secname}
8968 @itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
8969 Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all
8970 the input files. However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the
8971 @code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in
8972 your output program. If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a
8973 script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE}
8974 commands will appear in the linker output. You can still use other
8975 input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using
8976 @code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file.
8977
8978 @cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI)
8979 @item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname}
8980 Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname}
8981 in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file.
8982
8983 @var{in-secname} may be an integer.
8984
8985 @cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI)
8986 @item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression}
8987 Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}. The
8988 @var{expression} should be a power of two.
8989
8990 @cindex @code{BASE} (MRI)
8991 @item BASE @var{expression}
8992 Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than
8993 absolute addresses) in the output file.
8994
8995 @cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI)
8996 @item CHIP @var{expression}
8997 @itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression}
8998 This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
8999
9000 @cindex @code{END} (MRI)
9001 @item END
9002 This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility.
9003
9004 @cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI)
9005 @item FORMAT @var{output-format}
9006 Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker
9007 language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S}
9008
9009 @cindex @code{LIST} (MRI)
9010 @item LIST @var{anything}@dots{}
9011 Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
9012 @command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}.
9013
9014 The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the
9015 same line, with no change in its effect.
9016
9017 @cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI)
9018 @item LOAD @var{filename}
9019 @itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename}
9020 Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the
9021 same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld}
9022 command line.
9023
9024 @cindex @code{NAME} (MRI)
9025 @item NAME @var{output-name}
9026 @var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the
9027 MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line
9028 option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}.
9029
9030 @cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI)
9031 @item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9032 @itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname}
9033 Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the
9034 order in which they first appear in the input files. In an MRI-compatible
9035 script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command. The
9036 sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output
9037 file, in the order specified.
9038
9039 @cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI)
9040 @item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression}
9041 @itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression}
9042 @itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression}
9043 Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol
9044 @var{name} used in the linker input files.
9045
9046 @cindex @code{SECT} (MRI)
9047 @item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression}
9048 @itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression}
9049 @itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression}
9050 You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to
9051 specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}.
9052 If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same
9053 @var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address.
9054 @end table
9055
9056 @node GNU Free Documentation License
9057 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
9058 @include fdl.texi
9059
9060 @node LD Index
9061 @unnumbered LD Index
9062
9063 @printindex cp
9064
9065 @tex
9066 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
9067 % meantime:
9068 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
9069 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
9070 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
9071 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
9072 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
9073 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and}
9074 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
9075 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
9076 \page\colophon
9077 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91.
9078 @end tex
9079
9080 @bye